xref: /openbmc/linux/include/uapi/linux/nl80211.h (revision 3ac14b39)
1 #ifndef __LINUX_NL80211_H
2 #define __LINUX_NL80211_H
3 /*
4  * 802.11 netlink interface public header
5  *
6  * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
7  * Copyright 2008 Michael Wu <flamingice@sourmilk.net>
8  * Copyright 2008 Luis Carlos Cobo <luisca@cozybit.com>
9  * Copyright 2008 Michael Buesch <m@bues.ch>
10  * Copyright 2008, 2009 Luis R. Rodriguez <lrodriguez@atheros.com>
11  * Copyright 2008 Jouni Malinen <jouni.malinen@atheros.com>
12  * Copyright 2008 Colin McCabe <colin@cozybit.com>
13  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
14  * Copyright (C) 2018 Intel Corporation
15  *
16  * Permission to use, copy, modify, and/or distribute this software for any
17  * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above
18  * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies.
19  *
20  * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
21  * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
22  * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR
23  * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
24  * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN
25  * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF
26  * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
27  *
28  */
29 
30 /*
31  * This header file defines the userspace API to the wireless stack. Please
32  * be careful not to break things - i.e. don't move anything around or so
33  * unless you can demonstrate that it breaks neither API nor ABI.
34  *
35  * Additions to the API should be accompanied by actual implementations in
36  * an upstream driver, so that example implementations exist in case there
37  * are ever concerns about the precise semantics of the API or changes are
38  * needed, and to ensure that code for dead (no longer implemented) API
39  * can actually be identified and removed.
40  * Nonetheless, semantics should also be documented carefully in this file.
41  */
42 
43 #include <linux/types.h>
44 
45 #define NL80211_GENL_NAME "nl80211"
46 
47 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_CONFIG		"config"
48 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_SCAN		"scan"
49 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_REG		"regulatory"
50 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_MLME		"mlme"
51 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_VENDOR		"vendor"
52 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_NAN		"nan"
53 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_TESTMODE	"testmode"
54 
55 /**
56  * DOC: Station handling
57  *
58  * Stations are added per interface, but a special case exists with VLAN
59  * interfaces. When a station is bound to an AP interface, it may be moved
60  * into a VLAN identified by a VLAN interface index (%NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN).
61  * The station is still assumed to belong to the AP interface it was added
62  * to.
63  *
64  * Station handling varies per interface type and depending on the driver's
65  * capabilities.
66  *
67  * For drivers supporting TDLS with external setup (WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS
68  * and WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP), the station lifetime is as follows:
69  *  - a setup station entry is added, not yet authorized, without any rate
70  *    or capability information, this just exists to avoid race conditions
71  *  - when the TDLS setup is done, a single NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION is valid
72  *    to add rate and capability information to the station and at the same
73  *    time mark it authorized.
74  *  - %NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK is then used
75  *  - after this, the only valid operation is to remove it by tearing down
76  *    the TDLS link (%NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK)
77  *
78  * TODO: need more info for other interface types
79  */
80 
81 /**
82  * DOC: Frame transmission/registration support
83  *
84  * Frame transmission and registration support exists to allow userspace
85  * management entities such as wpa_supplicant react to management frames
86  * that are not being handled by the kernel. This includes, for example,
87  * certain classes of action frames that cannot be handled in the kernel
88  * for various reasons.
89  *
90  * Frame registration is done on a per-interface basis and registrations
91  * cannot be removed other than by closing the socket. It is possible to
92  * specify a registration filter to register, for example, only for a
93  * certain type of action frame. In particular with action frames, those
94  * that userspace registers for will not be returned as unhandled by the
95  * driver, so that the registered application has to take responsibility
96  * for doing that.
97  *
98  * The type of frame that can be registered for is also dependent on the
99  * driver and interface type. The frame types are advertised in wiphy
100  * attributes so applications know what to expect.
101  *
102  * NOTE: When an interface changes type while registrations are active,
103  *       these registrations are ignored until the interface type is
104  *       changed again. This means that changing the interface type can
105  *       lead to a situation that couldn't otherwise be produced, but
106  *       any such registrations will be dormant in the sense that they
107  *       will not be serviced, i.e. they will not receive any frames.
108  *
109  * Frame transmission allows userspace to send for example the required
110  * responses to action frames. It is subject to some sanity checking,
111  * but many frames can be transmitted. When a frame was transmitted, its
112  * status is indicated to the sending socket.
113  *
114  * For more technical details, see the corresponding command descriptions
115  * below.
116  */
117 
118 /**
119  * DOC: Virtual interface / concurrency capabilities
120  *
121  * Some devices are able to operate with virtual MACs, they can have
122  * more than one virtual interface. The capability handling for this
123  * is a bit complex though, as there may be a number of restrictions
124  * on the types of concurrency that are supported.
125  *
126  * To start with, each device supports the interface types listed in
127  * the %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES attribute, but by listing the
128  * types there no concurrency is implied.
129  *
130  * Once concurrency is desired, more attributes must be observed:
131  * To start with, since some interface types are purely managed in
132  * software, like the AP-VLAN type in mac80211 for example, there's
133  * an additional list of these, they can be added at any time and
134  * are only restricted by some semantic restrictions (e.g. AP-VLAN
135  * cannot be added without a corresponding AP interface). This list
136  * is exported in the %NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES attribute.
137  *
138  * Further, the list of supported combinations is exported. This is
139  * in the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute. Basically,
140  * it exports a list of "groups", and at any point in time the
141  * interfaces that are currently active must fall into any one of
142  * the advertised groups. Within each group, there are restrictions
143  * on the number of interfaces of different types that are supported
144  * and also the number of different channels, along with potentially
145  * some other restrictions. See &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
146  *
147  * All together, these attributes define the concurrency of virtual
148  * interfaces that a given device supports.
149  */
150 
151 /**
152  * DOC: packet coalesce support
153  *
154  * In most cases, host that receives IPv4 and IPv6 multicast/broadcast
155  * packets does not do anything with these packets. Therefore the
156  * reception of these unwanted packets causes unnecessary processing
157  * and power consumption.
158  *
159  * Packet coalesce feature helps to reduce number of received interrupts
160  * to host by buffering these packets in firmware/hardware for some
161  * predefined time. Received interrupt will be generated when one of the
162  * following events occur.
163  * a) Expiration of hardware timer whose expiration time is set to maximum
164  * coalescing delay of matching coalesce rule.
165  * b) Coalescing buffer in hardware reaches it's limit.
166  * c) Packet doesn't match any of the configured coalesce rules.
167  *
168  * User needs to configure following parameters for creating a coalesce
169  * rule.
170  * a) Maximum coalescing delay
171  * b) List of packet patterns which needs to be matched
172  * c) Condition for coalescence. pattern 'match' or 'no match'
173  * Multiple such rules can be created.
174  */
175 
176 /**
177  * DOC: WPA/WPA2 EAPOL handshake offload
178  *
179  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK flag drivers
180  * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
181  * preshared key authentication. In %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the preshared
182  * key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers supporting
183  * this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when no preshared
184  * key material is provided, for example when that driver does not
185  * support setting the temporal keys through %CMD_NEW_KEY.
186  *
187  * Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X flag can be
188  * set by drivers indicating offload support of the PTK/GTK EAPOL
189  * handshakes during 802.1X authentication. In order to use the offload
190  * the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT should have %NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS
191  * attribute flag. Drivers supporting this offload may reject the
192  * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when the attribute flag is not present.
193  *
194  * For 802.1X the PMK or PMK-R0 are set by providing %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
195  * using %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support also
196  * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME must be provided.
197  */
198 
199 /**
200  * DOC: FILS shared key authentication offload
201  *
202  * FILS shared key authentication offload can be advertized by drivers by
203  * setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
204  * FILS shared key authentication offload should be able to construct the
205  * authentication and association frames for FILS shared key authentication and
206  * eventually do a key derivation as per IEEE 802.11ai. The below additional
207  * parameters should be given to driver in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and/or in
208  * %NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS.
209  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME - used to construct keyname_nai
210  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM - used to construct keyname_nai
211  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used to construct erp message
212  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK - used to generate the rIK and rMSK
213  * rIK should be used to generate an authentication tag on the ERP message and
214  * rMSK should be used to derive a PMKSA.
215  * rIK, rMSK should be generated and keyname_nai, sequence number should be used
216  * as specified in IETF RFC 6696.
217  *
218  * When FILS shared key authentication is completed, driver needs to provide the
219  * below additional parameters to userspace, which can be either after setting
220  * up a connection or after roaming.
221  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - used for key renewal
222  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used in further EAP-RP exchanges
223  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID - used to identify the PMKSA used/generated
224  *	%Nl80211_ATTR_PMK - used to update PMKSA cache in userspace
225  * The PMKSA can be maintained in userspace persistently so that it can be used
226  * later after reboots or wifi turn off/on also.
227  *
228  * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the cache identifier advertized by a FILS
229  * capable AP supporting PMK caching. It specifies the scope within which the
230  * PMKSAs are cached in an ESS. %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and
231  * %NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA are enhanced to allow support for PMKSA caching based
232  * on FILS cache identifier. Additionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK is used with
233  * %NL80211_SET_PMKSA to specify the PMK corresponding to a PMKSA for driver to
234  * use in a FILS shared key connection with PMKSA caching.
235  */
236 
237 /**
238  * enum nl80211_commands - supported nl80211 commands
239  *
240  * @NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC: unspecified command to catch errors
241  *
242  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY: request information about a wiphy or dump request
243  *	to get a list of all present wiphys.
244  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY: set wiphy parameters, needs %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or
245  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX; can be used to set %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
246  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ (and the
247  *	attributes determining the channel width; this is used for setting
248  *	monitor mode channel),  %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT,
249  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD,
250  *	and/or %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD.
251  *	However, for setting the channel, see %NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL
252  *	instead, the support here is for backward compatibility only.
253  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY: Newly created wiphy, response to get request
254  *	or rename notification. Has attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and
255  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
256  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY: Wiphy deleted. Has attributes
257  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
258  *
259  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE: Request an interface's configuration;
260  *	either a dump request for all interfaces or a specific get with a
261  *	single %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is supported.
262  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE: Set type of a virtual interface, requires
263  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE.
264  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE: Newly created virtual interface or response
265  *	to %NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE. Has %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
266  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE attributes. Can also
267  *	be sent from userspace to request creation of a new virtual interface,
268  *	then requires attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE and
269  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME.
270  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE: Virtual interface was deleted, has attributes
271  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY. Can also be sent from
272  *	userspace to request deletion of a virtual interface, then requires
273  *	attribute %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
274  *
275  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY: Get sequence counter information for a key specified
276  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX and/or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
277  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: Set key attributes %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
278  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, or %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_THRESHOLD.
279  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: add a key with given %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
280  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
281  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ attributes.
282  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY: delete a key identified by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX
283  *	or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
284  *
285  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON: (not used)
286  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON: change the beacon on an access point interface
287  *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD and %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL
288  *	attributes. For drivers that generate the beacon and probe responses
289  *	internally, the following attributes must be provided: %NL80211_ATTR_IE,
290  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP and %NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP.
291  * @NL80211_CMD_START_AP: Start AP operation on an AP interface, parameters
292  *	are like for %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, and additionally parameters that
293  *	do not change are used, these include %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
294  *	%NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
295  *	%NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE,
296  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP, %NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
297  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, %NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
298  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
299  *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS.
300  *	The channel to use can be set on the interface or be given using the
301  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel width.
302  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
303  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP: Stop AP operation on the given interface
304  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP
305  *
306  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION: Get station attributes for station identified by
307  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
308  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION: Set station attributes for station identified by
309  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
310  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION: Add a station with given attributes to the
311  *	the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
312  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION: Remove a station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
313  *	or, if no MAC address given, all stations, on the interface identified
314  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE and
315  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE can optionally be used to specify which type
316  *	of disconnection indication should be sent to the station
317  *	(Deauthentication or Disassociation frame and reason code for that
318  *	frame).
319  *
320  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH: Get mesh path attributes for mesh path to
321  * 	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
322  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
323  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH:  Set mesh path attributes for mesh path to
324  * 	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
325  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
326  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH: Create a new mesh path for the destination given by
327  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC via %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP.
328  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH: Delete a mesh path to the destination given by
329  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
330  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PATH: Add a mesh path with given attributes to the
331  *	the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
332  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PATH: Remove a mesh path identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
333  *	or, if no MAC address given, all mesh paths, on the interface identified
334  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
335  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS: Set BSS attributes for BSS identified by
336  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
337  *
338  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_REG: ask the wireless core to send us its currently set
339  *	regulatory domain. If %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is specified and the device
340  *	has a private regulatory domain, it will be returned. Otherwise, the
341  *	global regdomain will be returned.
342  *	A device will have a private regulatory domain if it uses the
343  *	regulatory_hint() API. Even when a private regdomain is used the channel
344  *	information will still be mended according to further hints from
345  *	the regulatory core to help with compliance. A dump version of this API
346  *	is now available which will returns the global regdomain as well as
347  *	all private regdomains of present wiphys (for those that have it).
348  *	If a wiphy is self-managed (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG), then
349  *	its private regdomain is the only valid one for it. The regulatory
350  *	core is not used to help with compliance in this case.
351  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REG: Set current regulatory domain. CRDA sends this command
352  *	after being queried by the kernel. CRDA replies by sending a regulatory
353  *	domain structure which consists of %NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA set to our
354  *	current alpha2 if it found a match. It also provides
355  * 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, and a set of regulatory rules. Each
356  * 	regulatory rule is a nested set of attributes  given by
357  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FREQ_[START|END] and
358  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW with an attached power rule given by
359  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_ANT_GAIN and
360  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_EIRP.
361  * @NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG: ask the wireless core to set the regulatory domain
362  * 	to the specified ISO/IEC 3166-1 alpha2 country code. The core will
363  * 	store this as a valid request and then query userspace for it.
364  *
365  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG: Get mesh networking properties for the
366  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
367  *
368  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG: Set mesh networking properties for the
369  *      interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
370  *
371  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE: Set extra IEs for management frames. The
372  *	interface is identified with %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and the management
373  *	frame subtype with %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE. The extra IE data to be
374  *	added to the end of the specified management frame is specified with
375  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE. If the command succeeds, the requested data will be
376  *	added to all specified management frames generated by
377  *	kernel/firmware/driver.
378  *	Note: This command has been removed and it is only reserved at this
379  *	point to avoid re-using existing command number. The functionality this
380  *	command was planned for has been provided with cleaner design with the
381  *	option to specify additional IEs in NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
382  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
383  *	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, and NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
384  *
385  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN: get scan results
386  * @NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN: trigger a new scan with the given parameters
387  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
388  *	probe requests at CCK rate or not. %NL80211_ATTR_BSSID can be used to
389  *	specify a BSSID to scan for; if not included, the wildcard BSSID will
390  *	be used.
391  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS: scan notification (as a reply to
392  *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN and on the "scan" multicast group)
393  * @NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED: scan was aborted, for unspecified reasons,
394  *	partial scan results may be available
395  *
396  * @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN: start a scheduled scan at certain
397  *	intervals and certain number of cycles, as specified by
398  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS. If %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is
399  *	not specified and only %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL is specified,
400  *	scheduled scan will run in an infinite loop with the specified interval.
401  *	These attributes are mutually exculsive,
402  *	i.e. NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL must not be passed if
403  *	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is defined.
404  *	If for some reason scheduled scan is aborted by the driver, all scan
405  *	plans are canceled (including scan plans that did not start yet).
406  *	Like with normal scans, if SSIDs (%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS)
407  *	are passed, they are used in the probe requests.  For
408  *	broadcast, a broadcast SSID must be passed (ie. an empty
409  *	string).  If no SSID is passed, no probe requests are sent and
410  *	a passive scan is performed.  %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
411  *	if passed, define which channels should be scanned; if not
412  *	passed, all channels allowed for the current regulatory domain
413  *	are used.  Extra IEs can also be passed from the userspace by
414  *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_IE attribute.  The first cycle of the
415  *	scheduled scan can be delayed by %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY
416  *	is supplied. If the device supports multiple concurrent scheduled
417  *	scans, it will allow such when the caller provides the flag attribute
418  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI to indicate user-space support for it.
419  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN: stop a scheduled scan. Returns -ENOENT if
420  *	scheduled scan is not running. The caller may assume that as soon
421  *	as the call returns, it is safe to start a new scheduled scan again.
422  * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS: indicates that there are scheduled scan
423  *	results available.
424  * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED: indicates that the scheduled scan has
425  *	stopped.  The driver may issue this event at any time during a
426  *	scheduled scan.  One reason for stopping the scan is if the hardware
427  *	does not support starting an association or a normal scan while running
428  *	a scheduled scan.  This event is also sent when the
429  *	%NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN command is received or when the interface
430  *	is brought down while a scheduled scan was running.
431  *
432  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY: get survey resuls, e.g. channel occupation
433  *      or noise level
434  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS: survey data notification (as a reply to
435  *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY and on the "scan" multicast group)
436  *
437  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA: Add a PMKSA cache entry using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
438  *	(for the BSSID), %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and optionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
439  *	(PMK is used for PTKSA derivation in case of FILS shared key offload) or
440  *	using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
441  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMK in case of FILS
442  *	authentication where %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the identifier
443  *	advertized by a FILS capable AP identifying the scope of PMKSA in an
444  *	ESS.
445  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA: Delete a PMKSA cache entry, using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
446  *	(for the BSSID) and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID or using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
447  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID in case of FILS
448  *	authentication.
449  * @NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA: Flush all PMKSA cache entries.
450  *
451  * @NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE: indicates to userspace the regulatory domain
452  * 	has been changed and provides details of the request information
453  * 	that caused the change such as who initiated the regulatory request
454  * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR), the wiphy_idx
455  * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2) on which the request was made from if
456  * 	the initiator was %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE or
457  * 	%NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, the type of regulatory domain
458  * 	set (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE), if the type of regulatory domain is
459  * 	%NL80211_REG_TYPE_COUNTRY the alpha2 to which we have moved on
460  * 	to (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2).
461  * @NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT: indicates to userspace that an AP beacon
462  * 	has been found while world roaming thus enabling active scan or
463  * 	any mode of operation that initiates TX (beacons) on a channel
464  * 	where we would not have been able to do either before. As an example
465  * 	if you are world roaming (regulatory domain set to world or if your
466  * 	driver is using a custom world roaming regulatory domain) and while
467  * 	doing a passive scan on the 5 GHz band you find an AP there (if not
468  * 	on a DFS channel) you will now be able to actively scan for that AP
469  * 	or use AP mode on your card on that same channel. Note that this will
470  * 	never be used for channels 1-11 on the 2 GHz band as they are always
471  * 	enabled world wide. This beacon hint is only sent if your device had
472  * 	either disabled active scanning or beaconing on a channel. We send to
473  * 	userspace the wiphy on which we removed a restriction from
474  * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY) and the channel on which this occurred
475  * 	before (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE) and after (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER)
476  * 	the beacon hint was processed.
477  *
478  * @NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE: authentication request and notification.
479  *	This command is used both as a command (request to authenticate) and
480  *	as an event on the "mlme" multicast group indicating completion of the
481  *	authentication process.
482  *	When used as a command, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to identify the
483  *	interface. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify PeerSTAAddress (and
484  *	BSSID in case of station mode). %NL80211_ATTR_SSID is used to specify
485  *	the SSID (mainly for association, but is included in authentication
486  *	request, too, to help BSS selection. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used
487  *	to specify the frequence of the channel in MHz. %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE
488  *	is used to specify the authentication type. %NL80211_ATTR_IE is used to
489  *	define IEs (VendorSpecificInfo, but also including RSN IE and FT IEs)
490  *	to be added to the frame.
491  *	When used as an event, this reports reception of an Authentication
492  *	frame in station and IBSS modes when the local MLME processed the
493  *	frame, i.e., it was for the local STA and was received in correct
494  *	state. This is similar to MLME-AUTHENTICATE.confirm primitive in the
495  *	MLME SAP interface (kernel providing MLME, userspace SME). The
496  *	included %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute contains the management frame
497  *	(including both the header and frame body, but not FCS). This event is
498  *	also used to indicate if the authentication attempt timed out. In that
499  *	case the %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute is replaced with a
500  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT flag (and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to indicate which
501  *	pending authentication timed out).
502  * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE: association request and notification; like
503  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Association and Reassociation
504  *	(similar to MLME-ASSOCIATE.request, MLME-REASSOCIATE.request,
505  *	MLME-ASSOCIATE.confirm or MLME-REASSOCIATE.confirm primitives). The
506  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID attribute is used to specify whether the
507  *	request is for the initial association to an ESS (that attribute not
508  *	included) or for reassociation within the ESS (that attribute is
509  *	included).
510  * @NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE: deauthentication request and notification; like
511  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Deauthentication frames (similar to
512  *	MLME-DEAUTHENTICATION.request and MLME-DEAUTHENTICATE.indication
513  *	primitives).
514  * @NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE: disassociation request and notification; like
515  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Disassociation frames (similar to
516  *	MLME-DISASSOCIATE.request and MLME-DISASSOCIATE.indication primitives).
517  *
518  * @NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE: notification of a locally detected Michael
519  *	MIC (part of TKIP) failure; sent on the "mlme" multicast group; the
520  *	event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to describe the source MAC address of
521  *	the frame with invalid MIC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE to show the key
522  *	type, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX to indicate the key identifier, and
523  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ to indicate the TSC value of the frame; this
524  *	event matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() primitive
525  *
526  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS: Join a new IBSS -- given at least an SSID and a
527  *	FREQ attribute (for the initial frequency if no peer can be found)
528  *	and optionally a MAC (as BSSID) and FREQ_FIXED attribute if those
529  *	should be fixed rather than automatically determined. Can only be
530  *	executed on a network interface that is UP, and fixed BSSID/FREQ
531  *	may be rejected. Another optional parameter is the beacon interval,
532  *	given in the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL attribute, which if not
533  *	given defaults to 100 TU (102.4ms).
534  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS: Leave the IBSS -- no special arguments, the IBSS is
535  *	determined by the network interface.
536  *
537  * @NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE: testmode command, takes a wiphy (or ifindex) attribute
538  *	to identify the device, and the TESTDATA blob attribute to pass through
539  *	to the driver.
540  *
541  * @NL80211_CMD_CONNECT: connection request and notification; this command
542  *	requests to connect to a specified network but without separating
543  *	auth and assoc steps. For this, you need to specify the SSID in a
544  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute, and can optionally specify the association
545  *	IEs in %NL80211_ATTR_IE, %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP,
546  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ, %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
547  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
548  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
549  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, and
550  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT.
551  *	If included, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ are
552  *	restrictions on BSS selection, i.e., they effectively prevent roaming
553  *	within the ESS. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT
554  *	can be included to provide a recommendation of the initial BSS while
555  *	allowing the driver to roam to other BSSes within the ESS and also to
556  *	ignore this recommendation if the indicated BSS is not ideal. Only one
557  *	set of BSSID,frequency parameters is used (i.e., either the enforcing
558  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC,%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ or the less strict
559  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT).
560  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID can be used to request a reassociation within
561  *	the ESS in case the device is already associated and an association with
562  *	a different BSS is desired.
563  *	Background scan period can optionally be
564  *	specified in %NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
565  *	if not specified default background scan configuration
566  *	in driver is used and if period value is 0, bg scan will be disabled.
567  *	This attribute is ignored if driver does not support roam scan.
568  *	It is also sent as an event, with the BSSID and response IEs when the
569  *	connection is established or failed to be established. This can be
570  *	determined by the %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute (0 = success,
571  *	non-zero = failure). If %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT is included in the
572  *	event, the connection attempt failed due to not being able to initiate
573  *	authentication/association or not receiving a response from the AP.
574  *	Non-zero %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE value is indicated in that case as
575  *	well to remain backwards compatible.
576  *	When establishing a security association, drivers that support 4 way
577  *	handshake offload should send %NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event when
578  *	the 4 way handshake is completed successfully.
579  * @NL80211_CMD_ROAM: Notification indicating the card/driver roamed by itself.
580  *	When a security association was established with the new AP (e.g. if
581  *	the FT protocol was used for roaming or the driver completed the 4 way
582  *	handshake), this event should be followed by an
583  *	%NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event.
584  * @NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT: drop a given connection; also used to notify
585  *	userspace that a connection was dropped by the AP or due to other
586  *	reasons, for this the %NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP and
587  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE attributes are used.
588  *
589  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS: Set a wiphy's netns. Note that all devices
590  *	associated with this wiphy must be down and will follow.
591  *
592  * @NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Request to remain awake on the specified
593  *	channel for the specified amount of time. This can be used to do
594  *	off-channel operations like transmit a Public Action frame and wait for
595  *	a response while being associated to an AP on another channel.
596  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify which interface (and thus
597  *	radio) is used. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used to specify the
598  *	frequency for the operation.
599  *	%NL80211_ATTR_DURATION is used to specify the duration in milliseconds
600  *	to remain on the channel. This command is also used as an event to
601  *	notify when the requested duration starts (it may take a while for the
602  *	driver to schedule this time due to other concurrent needs for the
603  *	radio).
604  *	When called, this operation returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
605  *	that will be included with any events pertaining to this request;
606  *	the cookie is also used to cancel the request.
607  * @NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: This command can be used to cancel a
608  *	pending remain-on-channel duration if the desired operation has been
609  *	completed prior to expiration of the originally requested duration.
610  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the
611  *	radio. The %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attribute must be given as well to
612  *	uniquely identify the request.
613  *	This command is also used as an event to notify when a requested
614  *	remain-on-channel duration has expired.
615  *
616  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK: Set the mask of rates to be used in TX
617  *	rate selection. %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the interface
618  *	and @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES the set of allowed rates.
619  *
620  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME: Register for receiving certain mgmt frames
621  *	(via @NL80211_CMD_FRAME) for processing in userspace. This command
622  *	requires an interface index, a frame type attribute (optional for
623  *	backward compatibility reasons, if not given assumes action frames)
624  *	and a match attribute containing the first few bytes of the frame
625  *	that should match, e.g. a single byte for only a category match or
626  *	four bytes for vendor frames including the OUI. The registration
627  *	cannot be dropped, but is removed automatically when the netlink
628  *	socket is closed. Multiple registrations can be made.
629  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME for
630  *	backward compatibility
631  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME: Management frame TX request and RX notification. This
632  *	command is used both as a request to transmit a management frame and
633  *	as an event indicating reception of a frame that was not processed in
634  *	kernel code, but is for us (i.e., which may need to be processed in a
635  *	user space application). %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
636  *	frame contents (including header). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used
637  *	to indicate on which channel the frame is to be transmitted or was
638  *	received. If this channel is not the current channel (remain-on-channel
639  *	or the operational channel) the device will switch to the given channel
640  *	and transmit the frame, optionally waiting for a response for the time
641  *	specified using %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION. When called, this operation
642  *	returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) that will be included with the
643  *	TX status event pertaining to the TX request.
644  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
645  *	management frames at CCK rate or not in 2GHz band.
646  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX is an array of offsets to CSA
647  *	counters which will be updated to the current value. This attribute
648  *	is used during CSA period.
649  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL: When an off-channel TX was requested, this
650  *	command may be used with the corresponding cookie to cancel the wait
651  *	time if it is known that it is no longer necessary.
652  * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME for backward compatibility.
653  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a management frame
654  *	transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies
655  *	the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME includes the contents of the
656  *	frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included if the recipient acknowledged
657  *	the frame.
658  * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS for
659  *	backward compatibility.
660  *
661  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE: Set powersave, using %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
662  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE: Get powersave status in %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
663  *
664  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM: Connection quality monitor configuration. This command
665  *	is used to configure connection quality monitoring notification trigger
666  *	levels.
667  * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM: Connection quality monitor notification. This
668  *	command is used as an event to indicate the that a trigger level was
669  *	reached.
670  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL: Set the channel (using %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
671  *	and the attributes determining channel width) the given interface
672  *	(identifed by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX) shall operate on.
673  *	In case multiple channels are supported by the device, the mechanism
674  *	with which it switches channels is implementation-defined.
675  *	When a monitor interface is given, it can only switch channel while
676  *	no other interfaces are operating to avoid disturbing the operation
677  *	of any other interfaces, and other interfaces will again take
678  *	precedence when they are used.
679  *
680  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER: Set the MAC address of the peer on a WDS interface.
681  *
682  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST: Configure if this AP should perform
683  *	multicast to unicast conversion. When enabled, all multicast packets
684  *	with ethertype ARP, IPv4 or IPv6 (possibly within an 802.1Q header)
685  *	will be sent out to each station once with the destination (multicast)
686  *	MAC address replaced by the station's MAC address. Note that this may
687  *	break certain expectations of the receiver, e.g. the ability to drop
688  *	unicast IP packets encapsulated in multicast L2 frames, or the ability
689  *	to not send destination unreachable messages in such cases.
690  *	This can only be toggled per BSS. Configure this on an interface of
691  *	type %NL80211_IFTYPE_AP. It applies to all its VLAN interfaces
692  *	(%NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN), except for those in 4addr (WDS) mode.
693  *	If %NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED is not present with this
694  *	command, the feature is disabled.
695  *
696  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH: Join a mesh. The mesh ID must be given, and initial
697  *	mesh config parameters may be given.
698  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH: Leave the mesh network -- no special arguments, the
699  *	network is determined by the network interface.
700  *
701  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE: Unprotected deauthentication frame
702  *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
703  *	deauthentication frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
704  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE: Unprotected disassociation frame
705  *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
706  *	disassociation frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
707  *
708  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE: Notification on the reception of a
709  *      beacon or probe response from a compatible mesh peer.  This is only
710  *      sent while no station information (sta_info) exists for the new peer
711  *      candidate and when @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
712  *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, or
713  *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM is set.  On reception of this
714  *      notification, userspace may decide to create a new station
715  *      (@NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).  To stop this notification from
716  *      reoccurring, the userspace authentication daemon may want to create the
717  *      new station with the AUTHENTICATED flag unset and maybe change it later
718  *      depending on the authentication result.
719  *
720  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN: get Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
721  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN: set Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
722  *	Since wireless is more complex than wired ethernet, it supports
723  *	various triggers. These triggers can be configured through this
724  *	command with the %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute. For
725  *	more background information, see
726  *	http://wireless.kernel.org/en/users/Documentation/WoWLAN.
727  *	The @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN command can also be used as a notification
728  *	from the driver reporting the wakeup reason. In this case, the
729  *	@NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute will contain the reason
730  *	for the wakeup, if it was caused by wireless. If it is not present
731  *	in the wakeup notification, the wireless device didn't cause the
732  *	wakeup but reports that it was woken up.
733  *
734  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD: This command is used give the driver
735  *	the necessary information for supporting GTK rekey offload. This
736  *	feature is typically used during WoWLAN. The configuration data
737  *	is contained in %NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA (which is nested and
738  *	contains the data in sub-attributes). After rekeying happened,
739  *	this command may also be sent by the driver as an MLME event to
740  *	inform userspace of the new replay counter.
741  *
742  * @NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: This is used as an event to inform userspace
743  *	of PMKSA caching dandidates.
744  *
745  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER: Perform a high-level TDLS command (e.g. link setup).
746  *	In addition, this can be used as an event to request userspace to take
747  *	actions on TDLS links (set up a new link or tear down an existing one).
748  *	In such events, %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION indicates the requested
749  *	operation, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC contains the peer MAC address, and
750  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE the reason code to be used (only with
751  *	%NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN).
752  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT: Send a TDLS management frame. The
753  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION attribute determines the type of frame to be
754  *	sent. Public Action codes (802.11-2012 8.1.5.1) will be sent as
755  *	802.11 management frames, while TDLS action codes (802.11-2012
756  *	8.5.13.1) will be encapsulated and sent as data frames. The currently
757  *	supported Public Action code is %WLAN_PUB_ACTION_TDLS_DISCOVER_RES
758  *	and the currently supported TDLS actions codes are given in
759  *	&enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode.
760  *
761  * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME: Used by an application controlling an AP
762  *	(or GO) interface (i.e. hostapd) to ask for unexpected frames to
763  *	implement sending deauth to stations that send unexpected class 3
764  *	frames. Also used as the event sent by the kernel when such a frame
765  *	is received.
766  *	For the event, the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC attribute carries the TA and
767  *	other attributes like the interface index are present.
768  *	If used as the command it must have an interface index and you can
769  *	only unsubscribe from the event by closing the socket. Subscription
770  *	is also for %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME events.
771  *
772  * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME: Sent as an event indicating that the
773  *	associated station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC sent a 4addr frame
774  *	and wasn't already in a 4-addr VLAN. The event will be sent similarly
775  *	to the %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME event, to the same listener.
776  *
777  * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT: Probe an associated station on an AP interface
778  *	by sending a null data frame to it and reporting when the frame is
779  *	acknowleged. This is used to allow timing out inactive clients. Uses
780  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. The command returns a
781  *	direct reply with an %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE that is later used to match
782  *	up the event with the request. The event includes the same data and
783  *	has %NL80211_ATTR_ACK set if the frame was ACKed.
784  *
785  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS: Register this socket to receive beacons from
786  *	other BSSes when any interfaces are in AP mode. This helps implement
787  *	OLBC handling in hostapd. Beacons are reported in %NL80211_CMD_FRAME
788  *	messages. Note that per PHY only one application may register.
789  *
790  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP: sets a bitmap for the individual TIDs whether
791  *      No Acknowledgement Policy should be applied.
792  *
793  * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY: An AP or GO may decide to switch channels
794  *	independently of the userspace SME, send this event indicating
795  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is now on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the
796  *	attributes determining channel width.  This indication may also be
797  *	sent when a remotely-initiated switch (e.g., when a STA receives a CSA
798  *	from the remote AP) is completed;
799  *
800  * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY: Notify that a channel switch
801  *	has been started on an interface, regardless of the initiator
802  *	(ie. whether it was requested from a remote device or
803  *	initiated on our own).  It indicates that
804  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX will be on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
805  *	after %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT TBTT's.  The userspace may
806  *	decide to react to this indication by requesting other
807  *	interfaces to change channel as well.
808  *
809  * @NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE: Start the given P2P Device, identified by
810  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. It must have been created with
811  *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE previously. After it has been started, the
812  *	P2P Device can be used for P2P operations, e.g. remain-on-channel and
813  *	public action frame TX.
814  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE: Stop the given P2P Device, identified by
815  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier.
816  *
817  * @NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED: connection request to an AP failed; used to
818  *	notify userspace that AP has rejected the connection request from a
819  *	station, due to particular reason. %NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON
820  *	is used for this.
821  *
822  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE: Change the rate used to send multicast frames
823  *	for IBSS or MESH vif.
824  *
825  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL: sets ACL for MAC address based access control.
826  *	This is to be used with the drivers advertising the support of MAC
827  *	address based access control. List of MAC addresses is passed in
828  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS and ACL policy is passed in
829  *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. Driver will enable ACL with this list, if it
830  *	is not already done. The new list will replace any existing list. Driver
831  *	will clear its ACL when the list of MAC addresses passed is empty. This
832  *	command is used in AP/P2P GO mode. Driver has to make sure to clear its
833  *	ACL list during %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP.
834  *
835  * @NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT: Start a Channel availability check (CAC). Once
836  *	a radar is detected or the channel availability scan (CAC) has finished
837  *	or was aborted, or a radar was detected, usermode will be notified with
838  *	this event. This command is also used to notify userspace about radars
839  *	while operating on this channel.
840  *	%NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT is used to inform about the type of the
841  *	event.
842  *
843  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Get global nl80211 protocol features,
844  *	i.e. features for the nl80211 protocol rather than device features.
845  *	Returns the features in the %NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES bitmap.
846  *
847  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES: Pass down the most up-to-date Fast Transition
848  *	Information Element to the WLAN driver
849  *
850  * @NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT: Send a Fast transition event from the WLAN driver
851  *	to the supplicant. This will carry the target AP's MAC address along
852  *	with the relevant Information Elements. This event is used to report
853  *	received FT IEs (MDIE, FTIE, RSN IE, TIE, RICIE).
854  *
855  * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START: Indicates user-space will start running
856  *	a critical protocol that needs more reliability in the connection to
857  *	complete.
858  *
859  * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP: Indicates the connection reliability can
860  *	return back to normal.
861  *
862  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE: Get currently supported coalesce rules.
863  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE: Configure coalesce rules or clear existing rules.
864  *
865  * @NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Perform a channel switch by announcing the
866  *	the new channel information (Channel Switch Announcement - CSA)
867  *	in the beacon for some time (as defined in the
868  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT parameter) and then change to the
869  *	new channel. Userspace provides the new channel information (using
870  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel
871  *	width). %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX may be supplied to inform
872  *	other station that transmission must be blocked until the channel
873  *	switch is complete.
874  *
875  * @NL80211_CMD_VENDOR: Vendor-specified command/event. The command is specified
876  *	by the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID attribute and a sub-command in
877  *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD. Parameter(s) can be transported in
878  *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
879  *	For feature advertisement, the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute is
880  *	used in the wiphy data as a nested attribute containing descriptions
881  *	(&struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info) of the supported vendor commands.
882  *	This may also be sent as an event with the same attributes.
883  *
884  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP: Set Interworking QoS mapping for IP DSCP values.
885  *	The QoS mapping information is included in %NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP. If
886  *	that attribute is not included, QoS mapping is disabled. Since this
887  *	QoS mapping is relevant for IP packets, it is only valid during an
888  *	association. This is cleared on disassociation and AP restart.
889  *
890  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS: Ask the kernel to add a traffic stream for the given
891  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TSID and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC with %NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO
892  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME parameters.
893  *	Note that the action frame handshake with the AP shall be handled by
894  *	userspace via the normal management RX/TX framework, this only sets
895  *	up the TX TS in the driver/device.
896  *	If the admitted time attribute is not added then the request just checks
897  *	if a subsequent setup could be successful, the intent is to use this to
898  *	avoid setting up a session with the AP when local restrictions would
899  *	make that impossible. However, the subsequent "real" setup may still
900  *	fail even if the check was successful.
901  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS: Remove an existing TS with the %NL80211_ATTR_TSID
902  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameters. It isn't necessary to call this
903  *	before removing a station entry entirely, or before disassociating
904  *	or similar, cleanup will happen in the driver/device in this case.
905  *
906  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP: Get mesh path attributes for mesh proxy path to
907  *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
908  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
909  *
910  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB: Join the OCB network. The center frequency and
911  *	bandwidth of a channel must be given.
912  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB: Leave the OCB network -- no special arguments, the
913  *	network is determined by the network interface.
914  *
915  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer,
916  *	identified by the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameter. A target channel is
917  *	provided via %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes determining
918  *	channel width/type. The target operating class is given via
919  *	%NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS.
920  *	The driver is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching
921  *	operations and returning to the base channel for communication with the
922  *	AP.
923  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS
924  *	peer given by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Both peers must be on the base channel
925  *	when this command completes.
926  *
927  * @NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE: Similar to %NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, but used
928  *	as an event to indicate changes for devices with wiphy-specific regdom
929  *	management.
930  *
931  * @NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN: Stop an ongoing scan. Returns -ENOENT if a scan is
932  *	not running. The driver indicates the status of the scan through
933  *	cfg80211_scan_done().
934  *
935  * @NL80211_CMD_START_NAN: Start NAN operation, identified by its
936  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. This interface must have been
937  *	previously created with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE. After it
938  *	has been started, the NAN interface will create or join a
939  *	cluster. This command must have a valid
940  *	%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF attribute and optional
941  *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS attributes.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is
942  *	omitted or set to 0, it means don't-care and the device will
943  *	decide what to use.  After this command NAN functions can be
944  *	added.
945  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN: Stop the NAN operation, identified by
946  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface.
947  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION: Add a NAN function. The function is defined
948  *	with %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC nested attribute. When called, this
949  *	operation returns the strictly positive and unique instance id
950  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID) and a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
951  *	of the function upon success.
952  *	Since instance ID's can be re-used, this cookie is the right
953  *	way to identify the function. This will avoid races when a termination
954  *	event is handled by the user space after it has already added a new
955  *	function that got the same instance id from the kernel as the one
956  *	which just terminated.
957  *	This cookie may be used in NAN events even before the command
958  *	returns, so userspace shouldn't process NAN events until it processes
959  *	the response to this command.
960  *	Look at %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER as well.
961  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION: Delete a NAN function by cookie.
962  *	This command is also used as a notification sent when a NAN function is
963  *	terminated. This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID
964  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attributes.
965  * @NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG: Change current NAN
966  *	configuration. NAN must be operational (%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN
967  *	was executed).  It must contain at least one of the following
968  *	attributes: %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
969  *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is omitted, the
970  *	current configuration is not changed.  If it is present but
971  *	set to zero, the configuration is changed to don't-care
972  *	(i.e. the device can decide what to do).
973  * @NL80211_CMD_NAN_FUNC_MATCH: Notification sent when a match is reported.
974  *	This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH nested attribute and
975  *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE.
976  *
977  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS: Update one or more connect parameters
978  *	for subsequent roaming cases if the driver or firmware uses internal
979  *	BSS selection. This command can be issued only while connected and it
980  *	does not result in a change for the current association. Currently,
981  *	only the %NL80211_ATTR_IE data is used and updated with this command.
982  *
983  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, set the PMK or PMK-R0
984  *	for the given authenticator address (specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
985  *	When %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is set, %NL80211_ATTR_PMK specifies the
986  *	PMK-R0, otherwise it specifies the PMK.
987  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, delete the previously
988  *	configured PMK for the authenticator address identified by
989  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
990  * @NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED: An event that indicates that the 4 way
991  *	handshake was completed successfully by the driver. The BSSID is
992  *	specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Drivers that support 4 way handshake
993  *	offload should send this event after indicating 802.11 association with
994  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT or %NL80211_CMD_ROAM. If the 4 way handshake failed
995  *	%NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT should be indicated instead.
996  *
997  * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME: Control Port (e.g. PAE) frame TX request
998  *	and RX notification.  This command is used both as a request to transmit
999  *	a control port frame and as a notification that a control port frame
1000  *	has been received. %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
1001  *	frame contents.  The frame is the raw EAPoL data, without ethernet or
1002  *	802.11 headers.
1003  *	When used as an event indication %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
1004  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC are added
1005  *	indicating the protocol type of the received frame; whether the frame
1006  *	was received unencrypted and the MAC address of the peer respectively.
1007  *
1008  * @NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB: Request that the regdb firmware file is reloaded.
1009  *
1010  * @NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH: This interface is exclusively defined for host
1011  *	drivers that do not define separate commands for authentication and
1012  *	association, but rely on user space for the authentication to happen.
1013  *	This interface acts both as the event request (driver to user space)
1014  *	to trigger the authentication and command response (userspace to
1015  *	driver) to indicate the authentication status.
1016  *
1017  *	User space uses the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT command to the host driver to
1018  *	trigger a connection. The host driver selects a BSS and further uses
1019  *	this interface to offload only the authentication part to the user
1020  *	space. Authentication frames are passed between the driver and user
1021  *	space through the %NL80211_CMD_FRAME interface. Host driver proceeds
1022  *	further with the association after getting successful authentication
1023  *	status. User space indicates the authentication status through
1024  *	%NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute in %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH
1025  *	command interface.
1026  *
1027  *	Host driver reports this status on an authentication failure to the
1028  *	user space through the connect result as the user space would have
1029  *	initiated the connection through the connect request.
1030  *
1031  * @NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED: An event that notify station's
1032  *	ht opmode or vht opmode changes using any of %NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
1033  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,%NL80211_ATTR_NSS attributes with its
1034  *	address(specified in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1035  *
1036  * @NL80211_CMD_MAX: highest used command number
1037  * @__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST: internal use
1038  */
1039 enum nl80211_commands {
1040 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
1041 	NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC,
1042 
1043 	NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,		/* can dump */
1044 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY,
1045 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY,
1046 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY,
1047 
1048 	NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE,	/* can dump */
1049 	NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE,
1050 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE,
1051 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE,
1052 
1053 	NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY,
1054 	NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY,
1055 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY,
1056 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY,
1057 
1058 	NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON,
1059 	NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON,
1060 	NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1061 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1062 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1063 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1064 
1065 	NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION,
1066 	NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION,
1067 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION,
1068 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION,
1069 
1070 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH,
1071 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH,
1072 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH,
1073 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH,
1074 
1075 	NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS,
1076 
1077 	NL80211_CMD_SET_REG,
1078 	NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG,
1079 
1080 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG,
1081 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG,
1082 
1083 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE /* reserved; not used */,
1084 
1085 	NL80211_CMD_GET_REG,
1086 
1087 	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN,
1088 	NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
1089 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS,
1090 	NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED,
1091 
1092 	NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE,
1093 
1094 	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE,
1095 	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
1096 	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1097 	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE,
1098 
1099 	NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE,
1100 
1101 	NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT,
1102 
1103 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS,
1104 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS,
1105 
1106 	NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
1107 
1108 	NL80211_CMD_CONNECT,
1109 	NL80211_CMD_ROAM,
1110 	NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT,
1111 
1112 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS,
1113 
1114 	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY,
1115 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS,
1116 
1117 	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA,
1118 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA,
1119 	NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA,
1120 
1121 	NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1122 	NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1123 
1124 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK,
1125 
1126 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1127 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1128 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1129 	NL80211_CMD_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1130 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1131 	NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS = NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1132 
1133 	NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE,
1134 	NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE,
1135 
1136 	NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM,
1137 	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM,
1138 
1139 	NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL,
1140 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER,
1141 
1142 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL,
1143 
1144 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH,
1145 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH,
1146 
1147 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1148 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE,
1149 
1150 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE,
1151 
1152 	NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN,
1153 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN,
1154 
1155 	NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN,
1156 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN,
1157 	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS,
1158 	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED,
1159 
1160 	NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD,
1161 
1162 	NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
1163 
1164 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER,
1165 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT,
1166 
1167 	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME,
1168 
1169 	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT,
1170 
1171 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS,
1172 
1173 	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME,
1174 
1175 	NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP,
1176 
1177 	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY,
1178 
1179 	NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE,
1180 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE,
1181 
1182 	NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED,
1183 
1184 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE,
1185 
1186 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL,
1187 
1188 	NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT,
1189 
1190 	NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
1191 
1192 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES,
1193 	NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT,
1194 
1195 	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START,
1196 	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP,
1197 
1198 	NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE,
1199 	NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE,
1200 
1201 	NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1202 
1203 	NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
1204 
1205 	NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP,
1206 
1207 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS,
1208 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS,
1209 
1210 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP,
1211 
1212 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB,
1213 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB,
1214 
1215 	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY,
1216 
1217 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1218 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1219 
1220 	NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE,
1221 
1222 	NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN,
1223 
1224 	NL80211_CMD_START_NAN,
1225 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN,
1226 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION,
1227 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION,
1228 	NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG,
1229 	NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH,
1230 
1231 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST,
1232 
1233 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS,
1234 
1235 	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK,
1236 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK,
1237 
1238 	NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
1239 
1240 	NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB,
1241 
1242 	NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH,
1243 
1244 	NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED,
1245 
1246 	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME,
1247 
1248 	/* add new commands above here */
1249 
1250 	/* used to define NL80211_CMD_MAX below */
1251 	__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST,
1252 	NL80211_CMD_MAX = __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST - 1
1253 };
1254 
1255 /*
1256  * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new commands by defining them
1257  * here
1258  */
1259 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS
1260 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE
1261 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE
1262 #define NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE
1263 #define NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1264 #define NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE
1265 #define NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE
1266 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT
1267 
1268 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
1269 
1270 /* source-level API compatibility */
1271 #define NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG
1272 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG
1273 #define NL80211_MESH_SETUP_VENDOR_PATH_SEL_IE NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE
1274 
1275 /**
1276  * enum nl80211_attrs - nl80211 netlink attributes
1277  *
1278  * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC: unspecified attribute to catch errors
1279  *
1280  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY: index of wiphy to operate on, cf.
1281  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/<phyname>/index
1282  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME: wiphy name (used for renaming)
1283  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS: a nested array of TX queue parameters
1284  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ: frequency of the selected channel in MHz,
1285  *	defines the channel together with the (deprecated)
1286  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE attribute or the attributes
1287  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH and if needed %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
1288  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2
1289  * @NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH: u32 attribute containing one of the values
1290  *	of &enum nl80211_chan_width, describing the channel width. See the
1291  *	documentation of the enum for more information.
1292  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1: Center frequency of the first part of the
1293  *	channel, used for anything but 20 MHz bandwidth
1294  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2: Center frequency of the second part of the
1295  *	channel, used only for 80+80 MHz bandwidth
1296  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE: included with NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
1297  *	if HT20 or HT40 are to be used (i.e., HT disabled if not included):
1298  *	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT = HT not allowed (i.e., same as not including
1299  *		this attribute)
1300  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT20 = HT20 only
1301  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS = secondary channel is below the primary channel
1302  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS = secondary channel is above the primary channel
1303  *	This attribute is now deprecated.
1304  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1305  *	less than or equal to the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1306  *	dot11ShortRetryLimit; u8
1307  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1308  *	greater than the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1309  *	dot11ShortLongLimit; u8
1310  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD: fragmentation threshold, i.e., maximum
1311  *	length in octets for frames; allowed range: 256..8000, disable
1312  *	fragmentation with (u32)-1; dot11FragmentationThreshold; u32
1313  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD: RTS threshold (TX frames with length
1314  *	larger than or equal to this use RTS/CTS handshake); allowed range:
1315  *	0..65536, disable with (u32)-1; dot11RTSThreshold; u32
1316  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS: Coverage Class as defined by IEEE 802.11
1317  *	section 7.3.2.9; dot11CoverageClass; u8
1318  *
1319  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX: network interface index of the device to operate on
1320  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME: network interface name
1321  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE: type of virtual interface, see &enum nl80211_iftype
1322  *
1323  * @NL80211_ATTR_WDEV: wireless device identifier, used for pseudo-devices
1324  *	that don't have a netdev (u64)
1325  *
1326  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC: MAC address (various uses)
1327  *
1328  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
1329  *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
1330  *	keys
1331  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
1332  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
1333  *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
1334  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
1335  *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
1336  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT: Flag attribute indicating the key is default key
1337  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: Flag attribute indicating the key is the
1338  *	default management key
1339  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE: For crypto settings for connect or
1340  *	other commands, indicates which pairwise cipher suites are used
1341  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP: For crypto settings for connect or
1342  *	other commands, indicates which group cipher suite is used
1343  *
1344  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval in TU
1345  * @NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing
1346  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD: portion of the beacon before the TIM IE
1347  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL: portion of the beacon after the TIM IE
1348  *
1349  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID: Association ID for the station (u16)
1350  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1351  *	&enum nl80211_sta_flags (deprecated, use %NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2)
1352  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL: listen interval as defined by
1353  *	IEEE 802.11 7.3.1.6 (u16).
1354  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES: supported rates, array of supported
1355  *	rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1356  *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1357  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN: interface index of VLAN interface to move station
1358  *	to, or the AP interface the station was originally added to to.
1359  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO: information about a station, part of station info
1360  *	given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, nested attribute containing
1361  *	info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_info.
1362  *
1363  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS: Information about an operating bands,
1364  *	consisting of a nested array.
1365  *
1366  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID: mesh id (1-32 bytes).
1367  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION: action to perform on the mesh peer link
1368  *	(see &enum nl80211_plink_action).
1369  * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP: MAC address of the next hop for a mesh path.
1370  * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO: information about a mesh_path, part of mesh path
1371  * 	info given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, nested attribute described at
1372  *	&enum nl80211_mpath_info.
1373  *
1374  * @NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1375  *      &enum nl80211_mntr_flags.
1376  *
1377  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2: an ISO-3166-alpha2 country code for which the
1378  * 	current regulatory domain should be set to or is already set to.
1379  * 	For example, 'CR', for Costa Rica. This attribute is used by the kernel
1380  * 	to query the CRDA to retrieve one regulatory domain. This attribute can
1381  * 	also be used by userspace to query the kernel for the currently set
1382  * 	regulatory domain. We chose an alpha2 as that is also used by the
1383  * 	IEEE-802.11 country information element to identify a country.
1384  * 	Users can also simply ask the wireless core to set regulatory domain
1385  * 	to a specific alpha2.
1386  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES: a nested array of regulatory domain regulatory
1387  *	rules.
1388  *
1389  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (u8, 0 or 1)
1390  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1391  *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1392  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time enabled
1393  *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1394  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES: basic rates, array of basic
1395  *	rates in format defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1396  *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1397  *
1398  * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY: HT Capability information element (from
1399  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
1400  *
1401  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing all
1402  *	supported interface types, each a flag attribute with the number
1403  *	of the interface mode.
1404  *
1405  * @NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE: Management frame subtype for
1406  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE.
1407  *
1408  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE: Information element(s) data (used, e.g., with
1409  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE).
1410  *
1411  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can scan with
1412  *	a single scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1413  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can
1414  *	scan with a single scheduled scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1415  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information elements
1416  *	that can be added to a scan request
1417  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information
1418  *	elements that can be added to a scheduled scan request
1419  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS: maximum number of sets that can be
1420  *	used with @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, a wiphy attribute.
1421  *
1422  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES: nested attribute with frequencies (in MHz)
1423  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS: nested attribute with SSIDs, leave out for passive
1424  *	scanning and include a zero-length SSID (wildcard) for wildcard scan
1425  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS: scan result BSS
1426  *
1427  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR: indicates who requested the regulatory domain
1428  * 	currently in effect. This could be any of the %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_*
1429  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE: indicates the type of the regulatory domain currently
1430  * 	set. This can be one of the nl80211_reg_type (%NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_*)
1431  *
1432  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS: wiphy attribute that specifies
1433  *	an array of command numbers (i.e. a mapping index to command number)
1434  *	that the driver for the given wiphy supports.
1435  *
1436  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME: frame data (binary attribute), including frame header
1437  *	and body, but not FCS; used, e.g., with NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE and
1438  *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE events
1439  * @NL80211_ATTR_SSID: SSID (binary attribute, 0..32 octets)
1440  * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE: AuthenticationType, see &enum nl80211_auth_type,
1441  *	represented as a u32
1442  * @NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE: ReasonCode for %NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE and
1443  *	%NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, u16
1444  *
1445  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE: Key Type, see &enum nl80211_key_type, represented as
1446  *	a u32
1447  *
1448  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1449  * 	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1450  * 	the state of the channel _before_ the beacon hint processing. This
1451  * 	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1452  * 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1453  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1454  * 	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1455  * 	the state of the channel _after_ the beacon hint processing. This
1456  * 	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1457  * 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1458  *
1459  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES: a set of u32 values indicating the supported
1460  *	cipher suites
1461  *
1462  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED: a flag indicating the IBSS should not try to look
1463  *	for other networks on different channels
1464  *
1465  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT: a flag indicating than an operation timed out; this
1466  *	is used, e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE event
1467  *
1468  * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP: Whether management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) is
1469  *	used for the association (&enum nl80211_mfp, represented as a u32);
1470  *	this attribute can be used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
1471  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL is not allowed for
1472  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE since user space SME is expected and hence, it
1473  *	must have decided whether to use management frame protection or not.
1474  *	Setting %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL with a %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT request will
1475  *	let the driver (or the firmware) decide whether to use MFP or not.
1476  *
1477  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2: Attribute containing a
1478  *	&struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
1479  *
1480  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT: A flag indicating whether user space controls
1481  *	IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, in
1482  *	station mode. If the flag is included in %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1483  *	request, the driver will assume that the port is unauthorized until
1484  *	authorized by user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by
1485  *	default in station mode.
1486  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE: A 16-bit value indicating the
1487  *	ethertype that will be used for key negotiation. It can be
1488  *	specified with the associate and connect commands. If it is not
1489  *	specified, the value defaults to 0x888E (PAE, 802.1X). This
1490  *	attribute is also used as a flag in the wiphy information to
1491  *	indicate that protocols other than PAE are supported.
1492  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT: When included along with
1493  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, indicates that the custom
1494  *	ethertype frames used for key negotiation must not be encrypted.
1495  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: A flag indicating whether control
1496  *	port frames (e.g. of type given in %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE)
1497  *	will be sent directly to the network interface or sent via the NL80211
1498  *	socket.  If this attribute is missing, then legacy behavior of sending
1499  *	control port frames directly to the network interface is used.  If the
1500  *	flag is included, then control port frames are sent over NL80211 instead
1501  *	using %CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.  If control port routing over NL80211 is
1502  *	to be used then userspace must also use the %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
1503  *	flag.
1504  *
1505  * @NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA: Testmode data blob, passed through to the driver.
1506  *	We recommend using nested, driver-specific attributes within this.
1507  *
1508  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP: A flag indicating that the DISCONNECT
1509  *	event was due to the AP disconnecting the station, and not due to
1510  *	a local disconnect request.
1511  * @NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE: StatusCode for the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
1512  *	event (u16)
1513  * @NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY: Flag attribute, used with connect(), indicating
1514  *	that protected APs should be used. This is also used with NEW_BEACON to
1515  *	indicate that the BSS is to use protection.
1516  *
1517  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON
1518  *	to indicate which unicast key ciphers will be used with the connection
1519  *	(an array of u32).
1520  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1521  *	indicate which group key cipher will be used with the connection (a
1522  *	u32).
1523  * @NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1524  *	indicate which WPA version(s) the AP we want to associate with is using
1525  *	(a u32 with flags from &enum nl80211_wpa_versions).
1526  * @NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1527  *	indicate which key management algorithm(s) to use (an array of u32).
1528  *
1529  * @NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE: (Re)association request information elements as
1530  *	sent out by the card, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1531  * @NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE: (Re)association response information elements as
1532  *	sent by peer, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1533  *
1534  * @NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID: previous BSSID, to be used in ASSOCIATE and CONNECT
1535  *	commands to specify a request to reassociate within an ESS, i.e., to use
1536  *	Reassociate Request frame (with the value of this attribute in the
1537  *	Current AP address field) instead of Association Request frame which is
1538  *	used for the initial association to an ESS.
1539  *
1540  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY: key information in a nested attribute with
1541  *	%NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1542  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEYS: array of keys for static WEP keys for connect()
1543  *	and join_ibss(), key information is in a nested attribute each
1544  *	with %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1545  *
1546  * @NL80211_ATTR_PID: Process ID of a network namespace.
1547  *
1548  * @NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION: Used to indicate consistent snapshots for
1549  *	dumps. This number increases whenever the object list being
1550  *	dumped changes, and as such userspace can verify that it has
1551  *	obtained a complete and consistent snapshot by verifying that
1552  *	all dump messages contain the same generation number. If it
1553  *	changed then the list changed and the dump should be repeated
1554  *	completely from scratch.
1555  *
1556  * @NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR: Use 4-address frames on a virtual interface
1557  *
1558  * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO: survey information about a channel, part of
1559  *      the survey response for %NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, nested attribute
1560  *      containing info as possible, see &enum survey_info.
1561  *
1562  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKID: PMK material for PMKSA caching.
1563  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS: maximum number of PMKIDs a firmware can
1564  *	cache, a wiphy attribute.
1565  *
1566  * @NL80211_ATTR_DURATION: Duration of an operation in milliseconds, u32.
1567  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION: Device attribute that
1568  *	specifies the maximum duration that can be requested with the
1569  *	remain-on-channel operation, in milliseconds, u32.
1570  *
1571  * @NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE: Generic 64-bit cookie to identify objects.
1572  *
1573  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES: Nested set of attributes
1574  *	(enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes) describing TX rates per band. The
1575  *	enum nl80211_band value is used as the index (nla_type() of the nested
1576  *	data. If a band is not included, it will be configured to allow all
1577  *	rates based on negotiated supported rates information. This attribute
1578  *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK and with starting AP,
1579  *	and joining mesh networks (not IBSS yet). In the later case, it must
1580  *	specify just a single bitrate, which is to be used for the beacon.
1581  *	The driver must also specify support for this with the extended
1582  *	features NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
1583  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT and
1584  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT.
1585  *
1586  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH: A binary attribute which typically must contain
1587  *	at least one byte, currently used with @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME.
1588  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE: A u16 indicating the frame type/subtype for the
1589  *	@NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command.
1590  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1591  *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1592  *	information about which frame types can be transmitted with
1593  *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
1594  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1595  *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1596  *	information about which frame types can be registered for RX.
1597  *
1598  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK: Flag attribute indicating that the frame was
1599  *	acknowledged by the recipient.
1600  *
1601  * @NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE: powersave state, using &enum nl80211_ps_state values.
1602  *
1603  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM: connection quality monitor configuration in a
1604  *	nested attribute with %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_* sub-attributes.
1605  *
1606  * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE: Flag attribute to indicate that a command
1607  *	is requesting a local authentication/association state change without
1608  *	invoking actual management frame exchange. This can be used with
1609  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1610  *	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
1611  *
1612  * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE: (AP mode) Do not forward traffic between stations
1613  *	connected to this BSS.
1614  *
1615  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type. See
1616  *      &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for possible values.
1617  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL: Transmit power level in signed mBm units.
1618  *      This is used in association with @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING
1619  *      for non-automatic settings.
1620  *
1621  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN, which mostly
1622  *	means support for per-station GTKs.
1623  *
1624  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for transmitting.
1625  *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1626  *	not be used for transmitting. If an antenna is not selected in this
1627  *	bitmap the hardware is not allowed to transmit on this antenna.
1628  *
1629  *	Each bit represents one antenna, starting with antenna 1 at the first
1630  *	bit. Depending on which antennas are selected in the bitmap, 802.11n
1631  *	drivers can derive which chainmasks to use (if all antennas belonging to
1632  *	a particular chain are disabled this chain should be disabled) and if
1633  *	a chain has diversity antennas wether diversity should be used or not.
1634  *	HT capabilities (STBC, TX Beamforming, Antenna selection) can be
1635  *	derived from the available chains after applying the antenna mask.
1636  *	Non-802.11n drivers can derive wether to use diversity or not.
1637  *	Drivers may reject configurations or RX/TX mask combinations they cannot
1638  *	support by returning -EINVAL.
1639  *
1640  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for receiving.
1641  *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1642  *	not be used for receiving. If an antenna is not selected in this bitmap
1643  *	the hardware should not be configured to receive on this antenna.
1644  *	For a more detailed description see @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX.
1645  *
1646  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
1647  *	for configuration as TX antennas via the above parameters.
1648  *
1649  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
1650  *	for configuration as RX antennas via the above parameters.
1651  *
1652  * @NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE: Multicast tx rate (in 100 kbps) for IBSS
1653  *
1654  * @NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK: For management frame TX, the frame may be
1655  *	transmitted on another channel when the channel given doesn't match
1656  *	the current channel. If the current channel doesn't match and this
1657  *	flag isn't set, the frame will be rejected. This is also used as an
1658  *	nl80211 capability flag.
1659  *
1660  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE: HT operation mode (u16)
1661  *
1662  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
1663  *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
1664  *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
1665  *
1666  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP: Optional mesh setup parameters.  These cannot be
1667  *	changed once the mesh is active.
1668  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG: Mesh configuration parameters, a nested attribute
1669  *	containing attributes from &enum nl80211_meshconf_params.
1670  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH: Currently, this means the underlying driver
1671  *	allows auth frames in a mesh to be passed to userspace for processing via
1672  *	the @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH flag.
1673  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE: The state of a mesh peer link as defined in
1674  *	&enum nl80211_plink_state. Used when userspace is driving the peer link
1675  *	management state machine.  @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE or
1676  *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM must be enabled.
1677  *
1678  * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED: indicates, as part of the wiphy
1679  *	capabilities, the supported WoWLAN triggers
1680  * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS: used by %NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN to
1681  *	indicate which WoW triggers should be enabled. This is also
1682  *	used by %NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN to get the currently enabled WoWLAN
1683  *	triggers.
1684  *
1685  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL: Interval between scheduled scan
1686  *	cycles, in msecs.
1687  *
1688  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH: Nested attribute with one or more
1689  *	sets of attributes to match during scheduled scans.  Only BSSs
1690  *	that match any of the sets will be reported.  These are
1691  *	pass-thru filter rules.
1692  *	For a match to succeed, the BSS must match all attributes of a
1693  *	set.  Since not every hardware supports matching all types of
1694  *	attributes, there is no guarantee that the reported BSSs are
1695  *	fully complying with the match sets and userspace needs to be
1696  *	able to ignore them by itself.
1697  *	Thus, the implementation is somewhat hardware-dependent, but
1698  *	this is only an optimization and the userspace application
1699  *	needs to handle all the non-filtered results anyway.
1700  *	If the match attributes don't make sense when combined with
1701  *	the values passed in @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS (eg. if an SSID
1702  *	is included in the probe request, but the match attributes
1703  *	will never let it go through), -EINVAL may be returned.
1704  *	If ommited, no filtering is done.
1705  *
1706  * @NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the supported
1707  *	interface combinations. In each nested item, it contains attributes
1708  *	defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
1709  * @NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES: Nested attribute (just like
1710  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES) containing the interface types that
1711  *	are managed in software: interfaces of these types aren't subject to
1712  *	any restrictions in their number or combinations.
1713  *
1714  * @NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA: nested attribute containing the information
1715  *	necessary for GTK rekeying in the device, see &enum nl80211_rekey_data.
1716  *
1717  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES: rates per to be advertised as supported in scan,
1718  *	nested array attribute containing an entry for each band, with the entry
1719  *	being a list of supported rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but
1720  *	without the length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1721  *
1722  * @NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID: indicates whether SSID is to be hidden from Beacon
1723  *	and Probe Response (when response to wildcard Probe Request); see
1724  *	&enum nl80211_hidden_ssid, represented as a u32
1725  *
1726  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP: Information element(s) for Probe Response frame.
1727  *	This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to
1728  *	provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into Probe Response frames when the
1729  *	driver (or firmware) replies to Probe Request frames.
1730  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP: Information element(s) for (Re)Association
1731  *	Response frames. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and
1732  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into
1733  *	(Re)Association Response frames when the driver (or firmware) replies to
1734  *	(Re)Association Request frames.
1735  *
1736  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME: Nested attribute containing the wme configuration
1737  *	of the station, see &enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr.
1738  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD: the device supports uapsd when working
1739  *	as AP.
1740  *
1741  * @NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT: Indicates whether the firmware is capable of
1742  *	roaming to another AP in the same ESS if the signal lever is low.
1743  *
1744  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: Nested attribute containing the PMKSA caching
1745  *	candidate information, see &enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr.
1746  *
1747  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE: Indicates whether to use CCK rate or not
1748  *	for management frames transmission. In order to avoid p2p probe/action
1749  *	frames are being transmitted at CCK rate in 2GHz band, the user space
1750  *	applications use this attribute.
1751  *	This attribute is used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and
1752  *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME commands.
1753  *
1754  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION: Low level TDLS action code (e.g. link setup
1755  *	request, link setup confirm, link teardown, etc.). Values are
1756  *	described in the TDLS (802.11z) specification.
1757  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN: Non-zero token for uniquely identifying a
1758  *	TDLS conversation between two devices.
1759  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION: High level TDLS operation; see
1760  *	&enum nl80211_tdls_operation, represented as a u8.
1761  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT: A flag indicating the device can operate
1762  *	as a TDLS peer sta.
1763  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The TDLS discovery/setup and teardown
1764  *	procedures should be performed by sending TDLS packets via
1765  *	%NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT. Otherwise %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
1766  *	used for asking the driver to perform a TDLS operation.
1767  *
1768  * @NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME: This u32 attribute may be listed for devices
1769  *	that have AP support to indicate that they have the AP SME integrated
1770  *	with support for the features listed in this attribute, see
1771  *	&enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
1772  *
1773  * @NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK: Used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME, this tells
1774  *	the driver to not wait for an acknowledgement. Note that due to this,
1775  *	it will also not give a status callback nor return a cookie. This is
1776  *	mostly useful for probe responses to save airtime.
1777  *
1778  * @NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS: This u32 attribute contains flags from
1779  *	&enum nl80211_feature_flags and is advertised in wiphy information.
1780  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: Indicates that the HW responds to probe
1781  *	requests while operating in AP-mode.
1782  *	This attribute holds a bitmap of the supported protocols for
1783  *	offloading (see &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr).
1784  *
1785  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response template data. Contains the entire
1786  *	probe-response frame. The DA field in the 802.11 header is zero-ed out,
1787  *	to be filled by the FW.
1788  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT:  Force HT capable interfaces to disable
1789  *      this feature.  Currently, only supported in mac80211 drivers.
1790  * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the
1791  *      ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid.
1792  *      Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature.
1793  *      The values that may be configured are:
1794  *       MCS rates, MAX-AMSDU, HT-20-40 and HT_CAP_SGI_40
1795  *       AMPDU density and AMPDU factor.
1796  *      All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored
1797  *      by the driver as required.  The actual values may be seen in
1798  *      the station debugfs ht_caps file.
1799  *
1800  * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION: region for regulatory rules which this country
1801  *    abides to when initiating radiation on DFS channels. A country maps
1802  *    to one DFS region.
1803  *
1804  * @NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP: This u16 bitmap contains the No Ack Policy of
1805  *      up to 16 TIDs.
1806  *
1807  * @NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT: timeout value in seconds, this can be
1808  *	used by the drivers which has MLME in firmware and does not have support
1809  *	to report per station tx/rx activity to free up the staion entry from
1810  *	the list. This needs to be used when the driver advertises the
1811  *	capability to timeout the stations.
1812  *
1813  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM: signal strength in dBm (as a 32-bit int);
1814  *	this attribute is (depending on the driver capabilities) added to
1815  *	received frames indicated with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
1816  *
1817  * @NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD: Background scan period in seconds
1818  *      or 0 to disable background scan.
1819  *
1820  * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE: type of regulatory hint passed from
1821  *	userspace. If unset it is assumed the hint comes directly from
1822  *	a user. If set code could specify exactly what type of source
1823  *	was used to provide the hint. For the different types of
1824  *	allowed user regulatory hints see nl80211_user_reg_hint_type.
1825  *
1826  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON: The reason for which AP has rejected
1827  *	the connection request from a station. nl80211_connect_failed_reason
1828  *	enum has different reasons of connection failure.
1829  *
1830  * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA: Fields and elements in Authentication frames.
1831  *	This contains the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data),
1832  *	excluding the Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the
1833  *	Authentication transaction sequence number field. It is used with
1834  *	authentication algorithms that need special fields to be added into
1835  *	the frames (SAE and FILS). Currently, only the SAE cases use the
1836  *	initial two fields (Authentication transaction sequence number and
1837  *	Status code). However, those fields are included in the attribute data
1838  *	for all authentication algorithms to keep the attribute definition
1839  *	consistent.
1840  *
1841  * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY: VHT Capability information element (from
1842  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
1843  *
1844  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS: scan request control flags (u32)
1845  *
1846  * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW: P2P GO Client Traffic Window (u8), used with
1847  *	the START_AP and SET_BSS commands
1848  * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS: P2P GO opportunistic PS (u8), used with the
1849  *	START_AP and SET_BSS commands. This can have the values 0 or 1;
1850  *	if not given in START_AP 0 is assumed, if not given in SET_BSS
1851  *	no change is made.
1852  *
1853  * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
1854  *	defined in &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode.
1855  *
1856  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY: ACL policy, see &enum nl80211_acl_policy,
1857  *	carried in a u32 attribute
1858  *
1859  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS: Array of nested MAC addresses, used for
1860  *	MAC ACL.
1861  *
1862  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX: u32 attribute to advertise the maximum
1863  *	number of MAC addresses that a device can support for MAC
1864  *	ACL.
1865  *
1866  * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT: Type of radar event for notification to userspace,
1867  *	contains a value of enum nl80211_radar_event (u32).
1868  *
1869  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA: 802.11 extended capabilities that the kernel driver
1870  *	has and handles. The format is the same as the IE contents. See
1871  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for more information.
1872  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK: Extended capabilities that the kernel driver
1873  *	has set in the %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA value, for multibit fields.
1874  *
1875  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY: Station capabilities (u16) are advertised to
1876  *	the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS power save (PU-APSD).
1877  *
1878  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY: Station extended capabilities are
1879  *	advertised to the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS off channel operations
1880  *	and PU-APSD.
1881  *
1882  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: global nl80211 feature flags, see
1883  *	&enum nl80211_protocol_features, the attribute is a u32.
1884  *
1885  * @NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: flag attribute, userspace supports
1886  *	receiving the data for a single wiphy split across multiple
1887  *	messages, given with wiphy dump message
1888  *
1889  * @NL80211_ATTR_MDID: Mobility Domain Identifier
1890  *
1891  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC: Resource Information Container Information
1892  *	Element
1893  *
1894  * @NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID: critical protocol identifier requiring increased
1895  *	reliability, see &enum nl80211_crit_proto_id (u16).
1896  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION: duration in milliseconds in which
1897  *      the connection should have increased reliability (u16).
1898  *
1899  * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID: Association ID for the peer TDLS station (u16).
1900  *	This is similar to @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID but with a difference of being
1901  *	allowed to be used with the first @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION command to
1902  *	update a TDLS peer STA entry.
1903  *
1904  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: Coalesce rule information.
1905  *
1906  * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT: u32 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
1907  *	until the channel switch event.
1908  * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX: flag attribute specifying that transmission
1909  *	must be blocked on the current channel (before the channel switch
1910  *	operation).
1911  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES: Nested set of attributes containing the IE information
1912  *	for the time while performing a channel switch.
1913  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
1914  *	switch counters in the beacons tail (%NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL).
1915  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
1916  *	switch counters in the probe response (%NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP).
1917  *
1918  * @NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS: flags for nl80211_send_mgmt(), u32.
1919  *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags.
1920  *
1921  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS: array of supported channels.
1922  *
1923  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES: array of supported
1924  *      supported operating classes.
1925  *
1926  * @NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS: A flag indicating whether user space
1927  *	controls DFS operation in IBSS mode. If the flag is included in
1928  *	%NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS request, the driver will allow use of DFS
1929  *	channels and reports radar events to userspace. Userspace is required
1930  *	to react to radar events, e.g. initiate a channel switch or leave the
1931  *	IBSS network.
1932  *
1933  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
1934  *	5 MHz channel bandwidth.
1935  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
1936  *	10 MHz channel bandwidth.
1937  *
1938  * @NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF: Operating mode field from Operating Mode
1939  *	Notification Element based on association request when used with
1940  *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION or %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION (only when
1941  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE is supported, or with TDLS);
1942  *	u8 attribute.
1943  *
1944  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID: The vendor ID, either a 24-bit OUI or, if
1945  *	%NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX is set, a special Linux ID (not used yet)
1946  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD: vendor sub-command
1947  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA: data for the vendor command, if any; this
1948  *	attribute is also used for vendor command feature advertisement
1949  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS: used for event list advertising in the wiphy
1950  *	info, containing a nested array of possible events
1951  *
1952  * @NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP: IP DSCP mapping for Interworking QoS mapping. This
1953  *	data is in the format defined for the payload of the QoS Map Set element
1954  *	in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97.
1955  *
1956  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT: MAC address recommendation as initial BSS
1957  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT: frequency of the recommended initial BSS
1958  *
1959  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA: Device attribute that indicates how many
1960  *	associated stations are supported in AP mode (including P2P GO); u32.
1961  *	Since drivers may not have a fixed limit on the maximum number (e.g.,
1962  *	other concurrent operations may affect this), drivers are allowed to
1963  *	advertise values that cannot always be met. In such cases, an attempt
1964  *	to add a new station entry with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION may fail.
1965  *
1966  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX: An array of csa counter offsets (u16) which
1967  *	should be updated when the frame is transmitted.
1968  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS: U8 attribute used to advertise the maximum
1969  *	supported number of csa counters.
1970  *
1971  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY: flags for TDLS peer capabilities, u32.
1972  *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability.
1973  *
1974  * @NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER: Flag attribute, if set during interface
1975  *	creation then the new interface will be owned by the netlink socket
1976  *	that created it and will be destroyed when the socket is closed.
1977  *	If set during scheduled scan start then the new scan req will be
1978  *	owned by the netlink socket that created it and the scheduled scan will
1979  *	be stopped when the socket is closed.
1980  *	If set during configuration of regulatory indoor operation then the
1981  *	regulatory indoor configuration would be owned by the netlink socket
1982  *	that configured the indoor setting, and the indoor operation would be
1983  *	cleared when the socket is closed.
1984  *	If set during NAN interface creation, the interface will be destroyed
1985  *	if the socket is closed just like any other interface. Moreover, NAN
1986  *	notifications will be sent in unicast to that socket. Without this
1987  *	attribute, the notifications will be sent to the %NL80211_MCGRP_NAN
1988  *	multicast group.
1989  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the
1990  *	station will deauthenticate when the socket is closed.
1991  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS the IBSS will be automatically
1992  *	torn down when the socket is closed.
1993  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH the mesh setup will be
1994  *	automatically torn down when the socket is closed.
1995  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_START_AP the AP will be automatically
1996  *	disabled when the socket is closed.
1997  *
1998  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR: flag attribute indicating the current end is
1999  *	the TDLS link initiator.
2000  *
2001  * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM: flag for indicating whether the current connection
2002  *	shall support Radio Resource Measurements (11k). This attribute can be
2003  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests.
2004  *	User space applications are expected to use this flag only if the
2005  *	underlying device supports these minimal RRM features:
2006  *		%NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES,
2007  *		%NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET,
2008  *	Or, if global RRM is supported, see:
2009  *		%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM
2010  *	If this flag is used, driver must add the Power Capabilities IE to the
2011  *	association request. In addition, it must also set the RRM capability
2012  *	flag in the association request's Capability Info field.
2013  *
2014  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK: flag attribute used to enable ACK timeout
2015  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). In order to activate dynack
2016  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION feature flag must be set by lower
2017  *	drivers to indicate dynack capability. Dynack is automatically disabled
2018  *	setting valid value for coverage class.
2019  *
2020  * @NL80211_ATTR_TSID: a TSID value (u8 attribute)
2021  * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO: user priority value (u8 attribute)
2022  * @NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME: admitted time in units of 32 microseconds
2023  *	(per second) (u16 attribute)
2024  *
2025  * @NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE: SMPS mode to use (ap mode). see
2026  *	&enum nl80211_smps_mode.
2027  *
2028  * @NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS: operating class
2029  *
2030  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK: MAC address mask
2031  *
2032  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG: flag attribute indicating this device
2033  *	is self-managing its regulatory information and any regulatory domain
2034  *	obtained from it is coming from the device's wiphy and not the global
2035  *	cfg80211 regdomain.
2036  *
2037  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES: extended feature flags contained in a byte
2038  *	array. The feature flags are identified by their bit index (see &enum
2039  *	nl80211_ext_feature_index). The bit index is ordered starting at the
2040  *	least-significant bit of the first byte in the array, ie. bit index 0
2041  *	is located at bit 0 of byte 0. bit index 25 would be located at bit 1
2042  *	of byte 3 (u8 array).
2043  *
2044  * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS: Request overall radio statistics to be
2045  *	returned along with other survey data. If set, @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY
2046  *	may return a survey entry without a channel indicating global radio
2047  *	statistics (only some values are valid and make sense.)
2048  *	For devices that don't return such an entry even then, the information
2049  *	should be contained in the result as the sum of the respective counters
2050  *	over all channels.
2051  *
2052  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY: delay before the first cycle of a
2053  *	scheduled scan is started.  Or the delay before a WoWLAN
2054  *	net-detect scan is started, counting from the moment the
2055  *	system is suspended.  This value is a u32, in seconds.
2056 
2057  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR: flag attribute, if set indicates that the device
2058  *      is operating in an indoor environment.
2059  *
2060  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: maximum number of scan plans for
2061  *	scheduled scan supported by the device (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2062  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: maximum interval (in seconds) for
2063  *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2064  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: maximum number of iterations in
2065  *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2066  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: a list of scan plans for scheduled scan.
2067  *	Each scan plan defines the number of scan iterations and the interval
2068  *	between scans. The last scan plan will always run infinitely,
2069  *	thus it must not specify the number of iterations, only the interval
2070  *	between scans. The scan plans are executed sequentially.
2071  *	Each scan plan is a nested attribute of &enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan.
2072  * @NL80211_ATTR_PBSS: flag attribute. If set it means operate
2073  *	in a PBSS. Specified in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to request
2074  *	connecting to a PCP, and in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP to start
2075  *	a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG networks only.
2076  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT: nested attribute for driver supporting the
2077  *	BSS selection feature. When used with %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY it contains
2078  *	attributes according &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr to indicate what
2079  *	BSS selection behaviours are supported. When used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
2080  *	it contains the behaviour-specific attribute containing the parameters for
2081  *	BSS selection to be done by driver and/or firmware.
2082  *
2083  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS: whether P2P PS mechanism supported
2084  *	or not. u8, one of the values of &enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status
2085  *
2086  * @NL80211_ATTR_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
2087  *
2088  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA: Nested attribute of the following attributes:
2089  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
2090  *	%NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, to specify the extended capabilities per
2091  *	interface type.
2092  *
2093  * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA: array of 24 bytes that defines a MU-MIMO
2094  *	groupID for monitor mode.
2095  *	The first 8 bytes are a mask that defines the membership in each
2096  *	group (there are 64 groups, group 0 and 63 are reserved),
2097  *	each bit represents a group and set to 1 for being a member in
2098  *	that group and 0 for not being a member.
2099  *	The remaining 16 bytes define the position in each group: 2 bits for
2100  *	each group.
2101  *	(smaller group numbers represented on most significant bits and bigger
2102  *	group numbers on least significant bits.)
2103  *	This attribute is used only if all interfaces are in monitor mode.
2104  *	Set this attribute in order to monitor packets using the given MU-MIMO
2105  *	groupID data.
2106  *	to turn off that feature set all the bits of the groupID to zero.
2107  * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR: mac address for the sniffer to follow
2108  *	when using MU-MIMO air sniffer.
2109  *	to turn that feature off set an invalid mac address
2110  *	(e.g. FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF)
2111  *
2112  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF: The time at which the scan was actually
2113  *	started (u64). The time is the TSF of the BSS the interface that
2114  *	requested the scan is connected to (if available, otherwise this
2115  *	attribute must not be included).
2116  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID: The BSS according to which
2117  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF is set.
2118  * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION: measurement duration in TUs (u16). If
2119  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY is not set, this is the
2120  *	maximum measurement duration allowed. This attribute is used with
2121  *	measurement requests. It can also be used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN
2122  *	if the scan is used for beacon report radio measurement.
2123  * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY: flag attribute that indicates
2124  *	that the duration specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION is
2125  *	mandatory. If this flag is not set, the duration is the maximum duration
2126  *	and the actual measurement duration may be shorter.
2127  *
2128  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID: Association ID for the mesh peer (u16). This is
2129  *	used to pull the stored data for mesh peer in power save state.
2130  *
2131  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF: the master preference to be used by
2132  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and optionally with
2133  *	%NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG. Its type is u8 and it can't be 0.
2134  *	Also, values 1 and 255 are reserved for certification purposes and
2135  *	should not be used during a normal device operation.
2136  * @NL80211_ATTR_BANDS: operating bands configuration.  This is a u32
2137  *	bitmask of BIT(NL80211_BAND_*) as described in %enum
2138  *	nl80211_band.  For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0
2139  *	would be set.  This attribute is used with
2140  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, and
2141  *	it is optional.  If no bands are set, it means don't-care and
2142  *	the device will decide what to use.
2143  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC: a function that can be added to NAN. See
2144  *	&enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes for description of this nested
2145  *	attribute.
2146  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH: used to report a match. This is a nested attribute.
2147  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes.
2148  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK: KEK for FILS (Re)Association Request/Response frame
2149  *	protection.
2150  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES: Nonces (part of AAD) for FILS (Re)Association
2151  *	Request/Response frame protection. This attribute contains the 16 octet
2152  *	STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2153  *
2154  * @NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED: Indicates whether or not multicast
2155  *	packets should be send out as unicast to all stations (flag attribute).
2156  *
2157  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSSID: The BSSID of the AP. Note that %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is also
2158  *	used in various commands/events for specifying the BSSID.
2159  *
2160  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: Relative RSSI threshold by which
2161  *	other BSSs has to be better or slightly worse than the current
2162  *	connected BSS so that they get reported to user space.
2163  *	This will give an opportunity to userspace to consider connecting to
2164  *	other matching BSSs which have better or slightly worse RSSI than
2165  *	the current connected BSS by using an offloaded operation to avoid
2166  *	unnecessary wakeups.
2167  *
2168  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for BSSs in
2169  *	the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
2170  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI based comparision to figure out
2171  *	better BSSs. The attribute value is a packed structure
2172  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
2173  *
2174  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON: The reason for which an operation timed out.
2175  *	u32 attribute with an &enum nl80211_timeout_reason value. This is used,
2176  *	e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT event.
2177  *
2178  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP)
2179  *	username part of NAI used to refer keys rRK and rIK. This is used with
2180  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2181  *
2182  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) realm part
2183  *	of NAI specifying the domain name of the ER server. This is used with
2184  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2185  *
2186  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM: Unsigned 16-bit ERP next sequence number
2187  *	to use in ERP messages. This is used in generating the FILS wrapped data
2188  *	for FILS authentication and is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2189  *
2190  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) for the
2191  *	NAI specified by %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME and
2192  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM. This is used for generating rIK and rMSK
2193  *	from successful FILS authentication and is used with
2194  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2195  *
2196  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID: A 2-octet identifier advertized by a FILS AP
2197  *	identifying the scope of PMKSAs. This is used with
2198  *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA.
2199  *
2200  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK: attribute for passing PMK key material. Used with
2201  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA for the PMKSA identified by %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID.
2202  *	For %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT it is used to provide PSK for offloading 4-way
2203  *	handshake for WPA/WPA2-PSK networks. For 802.1X authentication it is
2204  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support this attribute
2205  *	specifies the PMK-R0 if NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is included as well.
2206  *
2207  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI: flag attribute which user-space shall use to
2208  *	indicate that it supports multiple active scheduled scan requests.
2209  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS: indicates maximum number of scheduled
2210  *	scan request that may be active for the device (u32).
2211  *
2212  * @NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS: flag attribute which user-space can include
2213  *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to indicate that for 802.1X authentication it
2214  *	wants to use the supported offload of the 4-way handshake.
2215  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME: PMK-R0 Name for offloaded FT.
2216  * @NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED: (reserved)
2217  *
2218  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION: Identify the requested external
2219  *     authentication operation (u32 attribute with an
2220  *     &enum nl80211_external_auth_action value). This is used with the
2221  *     %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH request event.
2222  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: Flag attribute indicating that the user
2223  *     space supports external authentication. This attribute shall be used
2224  *     only with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT request. The driver may offload
2225  *     authentication processing to user space if this capability is indicated
2226  *     in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests from the user space.
2227  *
2228  * @NL80211_ATTR_NSS: Station's New/updated  RX_NSS value notified using this
2229  *	u8 attribute. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED.
2230  *
2231  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS: TXQ statistics (nested attribute, see &enum
2232  *      nl80211_txq_stats)
2233  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT: Total packet limit for the TXQ queues for this phy.
2234  *      The smaller of this and the memory limit is enforced.
2235  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: Total memory memory limit (in bytes) for the
2236  *      TXQ queues for this phy. The smaller of this and the packet limit is
2237  *      enforced.
2238  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum (bytes). Number of bytes
2239  *      a flow is assigned on each round of the DRR scheduler.
2240  *
2241  * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR: total number of nl80211_attrs available
2242  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number currently defined
2243  * @__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
2244  */
2245 enum nl80211_attrs {
2246 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
2247 	NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC,
2248 
2249 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY,
2250 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
2251 
2252 	NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
2253 	NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME,
2254 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE,
2255 
2256 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC,
2257 
2258 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
2259 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX,
2260 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
2261 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ,
2262 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
2263 
2264 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
2265 	NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD,
2266 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD,
2267 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL,
2268 
2269 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID,
2270 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS,
2271 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL,
2272 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES,
2273 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN,
2274 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO,
2275 
2276 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS,
2277 
2278 	NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS,
2279 
2280 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID,
2281 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION,
2282 	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP,
2283 	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO,
2284 
2285 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT,
2286 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
2287 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
2288 
2289 	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY,
2290 
2291 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES,
2292 
2293 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2,
2294 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES,
2295 
2296 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG,
2297 
2298 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES,
2299 
2300 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS,
2301 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
2302 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE,
2303 
2304 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
2305 
2306 	NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE,
2307 	NL80211_ATTR_IE,
2308 
2309 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS,
2310 
2311 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
2312 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS,
2313 	NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION, /* replaces old SCAN_GENERATION */
2314 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS,
2315 
2316 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR,
2317 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE,
2318 
2319 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS,
2320 
2321 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME,
2322 	NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
2323 	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
2324 	NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE,
2325 
2326 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE,
2327 
2328 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN,
2329 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES,
2330 
2331 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE,
2332 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER,
2333 
2334 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED,
2335 
2336 
2337 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT,
2338 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
2339 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD,
2340 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD,
2341 
2342 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT,
2343 
2344 	NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP,
2345 
2346 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2,
2347 
2348 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
2349 
2350 	NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA,
2351 
2352 	NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
2353 
2354 	NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP,
2355 	NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE,
2356 
2357 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE,
2358 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP,
2359 	NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
2360 	NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES,
2361 
2362 	NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE,
2363 	NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE,
2364 
2365 	NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID,
2366 
2367 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY,
2368 	NL80211_ATTR_KEYS,
2369 
2370 	NL80211_ATTR_PID,
2371 
2372 	NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR,
2373 
2374 	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO,
2375 
2376 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKID,
2377 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS,
2378 
2379 	NL80211_ATTR_DURATION,
2380 
2381 	NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE,
2382 
2383 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS,
2384 
2385 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES,
2386 
2387 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH,
2388 
2389 	NL80211_ATTR_ACK,
2390 
2391 	NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE,
2392 
2393 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM,
2394 
2395 	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE,
2396 
2397 	NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE,
2398 
2399 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING,
2400 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL,
2401 
2402 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES,
2403 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES,
2404 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE,
2405 
2406 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
2407 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
2408 
2409 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN,
2410 
2411 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX,
2412 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX,
2413 
2414 	NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE,
2415 
2416 	NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK,
2417 
2418 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE,
2419 
2420 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
2421 
2422 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION,
2423 
2424 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP,
2425 
2426 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX,
2427 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX,
2428 
2429 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH,
2430 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE,
2431 
2432 	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS,
2433 	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED,
2434 
2435 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL,
2436 
2437 	NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS,
2438 	NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES,
2439 
2440 	NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA,
2441 
2442 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS,
2443 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN,
2444 
2445 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES,
2446 
2447 	NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID,
2448 
2449 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP,
2450 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP,
2451 
2452 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME,
2453 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD,
2454 
2455 	NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT,
2456 
2457 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH,
2458 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS,
2459 
2460 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
2461 
2462 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE,
2463 
2464 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION,
2465 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN,
2466 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION,
2467 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT,
2468 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP,
2469 
2470 	NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME,
2471 
2472 	NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK,
2473 
2474 	NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS,
2475 
2476 	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD,
2477 
2478 	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP,
2479 
2480 	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION,
2481 
2482 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT,
2483 	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
2484 
2485 	NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP,
2486 
2487 	NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
2488 
2489 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM,
2490 
2491 	NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
2492 
2493 	NL80211_ATTR_WDEV,
2494 
2495 	NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE,
2496 
2497 	NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON,
2498 
2499 	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA,
2500 
2501 	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY,
2502 
2503 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS,
2504 
2505 	NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,
2506 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1,
2507 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2,
2508 
2509 	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW,
2510 	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS,
2511 
2512 	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE,
2513 
2514 	NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY,
2515 
2516 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS,
2517 
2518 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX,
2519 
2520 	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT,
2521 
2522 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
2523 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK,
2524 
2525 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY,
2526 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY,
2527 
2528 	NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
2529 	NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP,
2530 
2531 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT,
2532 	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
2533 
2534 	NL80211_ATTR_MDID,
2535 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC,
2536 
2537 	NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID,
2538 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION,
2539 
2540 	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID,
2541 
2542 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
2543 
2544 	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT,
2545 	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX,
2546 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES,
2547 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON,
2548 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP,
2549 
2550 	NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS,
2551 
2552 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS,
2553 
2554 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES,
2555 
2556 	NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS,
2557 
2558 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ,
2559 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ,
2560 
2561 	NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF,
2562 
2563 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID,
2564 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD,
2565 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
2566 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS,
2567 
2568 	NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP,
2569 
2570 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT,
2571 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT,
2572 
2573 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA,
2574 
2575 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY,
2576 
2577 	NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER,
2578 
2579 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX,
2580 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS,
2581 
2582 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR,
2583 
2584 	NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM,
2585 
2586 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK,
2587 
2588 	NL80211_ATTR_TSID,
2589 	NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO,
2590 	NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME,
2591 
2592 	NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
2593 
2594 	NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS,
2595 
2596 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK,
2597 
2598 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG,
2599 
2600 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES,
2601 
2602 	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS,
2603 
2604 	NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD,
2605 
2606 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY,
2607 
2608 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR,
2609 
2610 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
2611 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
2612 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
2613 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
2614 
2615 	NL80211_ATTR_PBSS,
2616 
2617 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT,
2618 
2619 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS,
2620 
2621 	NL80211_ATTR_PAD,
2622 
2623 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA,
2624 
2625 	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA,
2626 	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR,
2627 
2628 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF,
2629 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID,
2630 	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION,
2631 	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY,
2632 
2633 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID,
2634 
2635 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
2636 	NL80211_ATTR_BANDS,
2637 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC,
2638 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH,
2639 
2640 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK,
2641 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES,
2642 
2643 	NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED,
2644 
2645 	NL80211_ATTR_BSSID,
2646 
2647 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
2648 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST,
2649 
2650 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON,
2651 
2652 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME,
2653 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM,
2654 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM,
2655 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK,
2656 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
2657 
2658 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK,
2659 
2660 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI,
2661 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS,
2662 
2663 	NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS,
2664 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME,
2665 	NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
2666 
2667 	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION,
2668 	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT,
2669 
2670 	NL80211_ATTR_NSS,
2671 	NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL,
2672 
2673 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
2674 
2675 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS,
2676 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT,
2677 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT,
2678 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM,
2679 
2680 	/* add attributes here, update the policy in nl80211.c */
2681 
2682 	__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
2683 	NUM_NL80211_ATTR = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
2684 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
2685 };
2686 
2687 /* source-level API compatibility */
2688 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_GENERATION NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION
2689 #define	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG
2690 #define NL80211_ATTR_IFACE_SOCKET_OWNER NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
2691 #define NL80211_ATTR_SAE_DATA NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA
2692 
2693 /*
2694  * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new attributes by defining them
2695  * here
2696  */
2697 #define NL80211_CMD_CONNECT NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
2698 #define NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY
2699 #define NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES
2700 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS
2701 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
2702 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE
2703 #define NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE
2704 #define NL80211_ATTR_IE NL80211_ATTR_IE
2705 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR
2706 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE
2707 #define NL80211_ATTR_FRAME NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
2708 #define NL80211_ATTR_SSID NL80211_ATTR_SSID
2709 #define NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE
2710 #define NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE
2711 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE
2712 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP
2713 #define NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS
2714 #define NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES
2715 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEY NL80211_ATTR_KEY
2716 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEYS NL80211_ATTR_KEYS
2717 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
2718 
2719 #define NL80211_WIPHY_NAME_MAXLEN		64
2720 
2721 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES			32
2722 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_HT_RATES		77
2723 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_REG_RULES		64
2724 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_ENCR_KEY	0
2725 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_TX_MIC_KEY	16
2726 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_RX_MIC_KEY	24
2727 #define NL80211_HT_CAPABILITY_LEN		26
2728 #define NL80211_VHT_CAPABILITY_LEN		12
2729 
2730 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES		5
2731 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES		2
2732 
2733 #define NL80211_MIN_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_TIME	10
2734 
2735 /* default RSSI threshold for scan results if none specified. */
2736 #define NL80211_SCAN_RSSI_THOLD_OFF		-300
2737 
2738 #define NL80211_CQM_TXE_MAX_INTVL		1800
2739 
2740 /**
2741  * enum nl80211_iftype - (virtual) interface types
2742  *
2743  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified type, driver decides
2744  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC: independent BSS member
2745  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: managed BSS member
2746  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: access point
2747  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN: VLAN interface for access points; VLAN interfaces
2748  *	are a bit special in that they must always be tied to a pre-existing
2749  *	AP type interface.
2750  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS: wireless distribution interface
2751  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR: monitor interface receiving all frames
2752  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT: mesh point
2753  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT: P2P client
2754  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO: P2P group owner
2755  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE: P2P device interface type, this is not a netdev
2756  *	and therefore can't be created in the normal ways, use the
2757  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE and %NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE
2758  *	commands to create and destroy one
2759  * @NL80211_IF_TYPE_OCB: Outside Context of a BSS
2760  *	This mode corresponds to the MIB variable dot11OCBActivated=true
2761  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN: NAN device interface type (not a netdev)
2762  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX: highest interface type number currently defined
2763  * @NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES: number of defined interface types
2764  *
2765  * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE
2766  * to set the type of an interface.
2767  *
2768  */
2769 enum nl80211_iftype {
2770 	NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED,
2771 	NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC,
2772 	NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION,
2773 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP,
2774 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN,
2775 	NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS,
2776 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR,
2777 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT,
2778 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT,
2779 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO,
2780 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE,
2781 	NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB,
2782 	NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN,
2783 
2784 	/* keep last */
2785 	NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES,
2786 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES - 1
2787 };
2788 
2789 /**
2790  * enum nl80211_sta_flags - station flags
2791  *
2792  * Station flags. When a station is added to an AP interface, it is
2793  * assumed to be already associated (and hence authenticated.)
2794  *
2795  * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
2796  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2797  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE: station is capable of receiving frames
2798  *	with short barker preamble
2799  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME: station is WME/QoS capable
2800  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP: station uses management frame protection
2801  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED: station is authenticated
2802  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER: station is a TDLS peer -- this flag should
2803  *	only be used in managed mode (even in the flags mask). Note that the
2804  *	flag can't be changed, it is only valid while adding a station, and
2805  *	attempts to change it will silently be ignored (rather than rejected
2806  *	as errors.)
2807  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED: station is associated; used with drivers
2808  *	that support %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE to transition a
2809  *	previously added station into associated state
2810  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX: highest station flag number currently defined
2811  * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
2812  */
2813 enum nl80211_sta_flags {
2814 	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID,
2815 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED,
2816 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
2817 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME,
2818 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP,
2819 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED,
2820 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER,
2821 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED,
2822 
2823 	/* keep last */
2824 	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
2825 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
2826 };
2827 
2828 /**
2829  * enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status - station support of P2P PS
2830  *
2831  * @NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED: station doesn't support P2P PS mechanism
2832  * @@NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED: station supports P2P PS mechanism
2833  * @NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS: number of values
2834  */
2835 enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status {
2836 	NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED = 0,
2837 	NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED,
2838 
2839 	NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS,
2840 };
2841 
2842 #define NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX_OLD_API	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER
2843 
2844 /**
2845  * struct nl80211_sta_flag_update - station flags mask/set
2846  * @mask: mask of station flags to set
2847  * @set: which values to set them to
2848  *
2849  * Both mask and set contain bits as per &enum nl80211_sta_flags.
2850  */
2851 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update {
2852 	__u32 mask;
2853 	__u32 set;
2854 } __attribute__((packed));
2855 
2856 /**
2857  * enum nl80211_rate_info - bitrate information
2858  *
2859  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_TXRATE
2860  * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
2861  * There are 2 attributes for bitrate, a legacy one that represents
2862  * a 16-bit value, and new one that represents a 32-bit value.
2863  * If the rate value fits into 16 bit, both attributes are reported
2864  * with the same value. If the rate is too high to fit into 16 bits
2865  * (>6.5535Gbps) only 32-bit attribute is included.
2866  * User space tools encouraged to use the 32-bit attribute and fall
2867  * back to the 16-bit one for compatibility with older kernels.
2868  *
2869  * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
2870  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE: total bitrate (u16, 100kbit/s)
2871  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS: mcs index for 802.11n (u8)
2872  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH: 40 MHz dualchannel bitrate
2873  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
2874  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32: total bitrate (u32, 100kbit/s)
2875  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX: highest rate_info number currently defined
2876  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS: MCS index for VHT (u8)
2877  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS: number of streams in VHT (u8)
2878  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH: 80 MHz VHT rate
2879  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH: unused - 80+80 is treated the
2880  *	same as 160 for purposes of the bitrates
2881  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH: 160 MHz VHT rate
2882  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH: 10 MHz width - note that this is
2883  *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
2884  *	half the base (20 MHz) rate
2885  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH: 5 MHz width - note that this is
2886  *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
2887  *	a quarter of the base (20 MHz) rate
2888  * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
2889  */
2890 enum nl80211_rate_info {
2891 	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID,
2892 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE,
2893 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS,
2894 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH,
2895 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI,
2896 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32,
2897 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS,
2898 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS,
2899 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH,
2900 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH,
2901 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH,
2902 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH,
2903 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH,
2904 
2905 	/* keep last */
2906 	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
2907 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
2908 };
2909 
2910 /**
2911  * enum nl80211_sta_bss_param - BSS information collected by STA
2912  *
2913  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM
2914  * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
2915  *
2916  * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
2917  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (flag)
2918  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE:  whether short preamble is enabled
2919  *	(flag)
2920  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME:  whether short slot time is enabled
2921  *	(flag)
2922  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing (u8)
2923  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL: Beacon interval (u16)
2924  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX: highest sta_bss_param number currently defined
2925  * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST: internal use
2926  */
2927 enum nl80211_sta_bss_param {
2928 	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID,
2929 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT,
2930 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
2931 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
2932 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD,
2933 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL,
2934 
2935 	/* keep last */
2936 	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST,
2937 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX = __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST - 1
2938 };
2939 
2940 /**
2941  * enum nl80211_sta_info - station information
2942  *
2943  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO
2944  * when getting information about a station.
2945  *
2946  * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
2947  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME: time since last activity (u32, msecs)
2948  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES: total received bytes (MPDU length)
2949  *	(u32, from this station)
2950  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
2951  *	(u32, to this station)
2952  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64: total received bytes (MPDU length)
2953  *	(u64, from this station)
2954  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
2955  *	(u64, to this station)
2956  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL: signal strength of last received PPDU (u8, dBm)
2957  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE: current unicast tx rate, nested attribute
2958  * 	containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_rate_info
2959  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS: total received packet (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
2960  *	(u32, from this station)
2961  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS: total transmitted packets (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
2962  *	(u32, to this station)
2963  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES: total retries (MPDUs) (u32, to this station)
2964  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED: total failed packets (MPDUs)
2965  *	(u32, to this station)
2966  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average (u8, dBm)
2967  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID: the station's mesh LLID
2968  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID: the station's mesh PLID
2969  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE: peer link state for the station
2970  *	(see %enum nl80211_plink_state)
2971  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE: last unicast data frame rx rate, nested
2972  *	attribute, like NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE.
2973  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM: current station's view of BSS, nested attribute
2974  *     containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_bss_param
2975  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME: time since the station is last connected
2976  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS: Contains a struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
2977  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS: count of times beacon loss was detected (u32)
2978  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET: timing offset with respect to this STA (s64)
2979  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
2980  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM: peer mesh STA link-specific power mode
2981  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM: neighbor mesh STA power save mode towards
2982  *	non-peer STA
2983  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last PPDU
2984  *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm)
2985  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG: per-chain signal strength average
2986  *	Same format as NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL.
2987  * @NL80211_STA_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT: expected throughput considering also the
2988  *	802.11 header (u32, kbps)
2989  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC: RX packets dropped for unspecified reasons
2990  *	(u64)
2991  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX: number of beacons received from this peer (u64)
2992  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average
2993  *	for beacons only (u8, dBm)
2994  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS: per-TID statistics (see &enum nl80211_tid_stats)
2995  *	This is a nested attribute where each the inner attribute number is the
2996  *	TID+1 and the special TID 16 (i.e. value 17) is used for non-QoS frames;
2997  *	each one of those is again nested with &enum nl80211_tid_stats
2998  *	attributes carrying the actual values.
2999  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3000  *	received from the station (u64, usec)
3001  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3002  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL: signal strength of the last ACK frame(u8, dBm)
3003  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG: avg signal strength of (data)
3004  *	ACK frame (s8, dBm)
3005  * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal
3006  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX: highest possible station info attribute
3007  */
3008 enum nl80211_sta_info {
3009 	__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID,
3010 	NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME,
3011 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES,
3012 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES,
3013 	NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID,
3014 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID,
3015 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE,
3016 	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL,
3017 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE,
3018 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS,
3019 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS,
3020 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES,
3021 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED,
3022 	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG,
3023 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE,
3024 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM,
3025 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME,
3026 	NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS,
3027 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS,
3028 	NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET,
3029 	NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM,
3030 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM,
3031 	NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM,
3032 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64,
3033 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64,
3034 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
3035 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG,
3036 	NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT,
3037 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC,
3038 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX,
3039 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG,
3040 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS,
3041 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION,
3042 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD,
3043 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL,
3044 	NL80211_STA_INFO_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG,
3045 
3046 	/* keep last */
3047 	__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3048 	NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3049 };
3050 
3051 /**
3052  * enum nl80211_tid_stats - per TID statistics attributes
3053  * @__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3054  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU: number of MSDUs received (u64)
3055  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU: number of MSDUs transmitted (or
3056  *	attempted to transmit; u64)
3057  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES: number of retries for
3058  *	transmitted MSDUs (not counting the first attempt; u64)
3059  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED: number of failed transmitted
3060  *	MSDUs (u64)
3061  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3062  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS: TXQ stats (nested attribute)
3063  * @NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS: number of attributes here
3064  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
3065  */
3066 enum nl80211_tid_stats {
3067 	__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID,
3068 	NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU,
3069 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU,
3070 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES,
3071 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED,
3072 	NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD,
3073 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS,
3074 
3075 	/* keep last */
3076 	NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS,
3077 	NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS - 1
3078 };
3079 
3080 /**
3081  * enum nl80211_txq_stats - per TXQ statistics attributes
3082  * @__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3083  * @NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS: number of attributes here
3084  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES: number of bytes currently backlogged
3085  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS: number of packets currently
3086  *      backlogged
3087  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS: total number of new flows seen
3088  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS: total number of packet drops
3089  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS: total number of packet ECN marks
3090  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT: number of drops due to queue space overflow
3091  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
3092  *      (only for per-phy stats)
3093  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS: number of hash collisions
3094  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES: total number of bytes dequeued from TXQ
3095  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS: total number of packets dequeued from TXQ
3096  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS: number of flow buckets for PHY
3097  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
3098  */
3099 enum nl80211_txq_stats {
3100 	__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID,
3101 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES,
3102 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS,
3103 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS,
3104 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS,
3105 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS,
3106 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT,
3107 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY,
3108 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS,
3109 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES,
3110 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS,
3111 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS,
3112 
3113 	/* keep last */
3114 	NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS,
3115 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS - 1
3116 };
3117 
3118 /**
3119  * enum nl80211_mpath_flags - nl80211 mesh path flags
3120  *
3121  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE: the mesh path is active
3122  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING: the mesh path discovery process is running
3123  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID: the mesh path contains a valid SN
3124  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED: the mesh path has been manually set
3125  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED: the mesh path discovery process succeeded
3126  */
3127 enum nl80211_mpath_flags {
3128 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE =	1<<0,
3129 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING =	1<<1,
3130 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID =	1<<2,
3131 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED =	1<<3,
3132 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED =	1<<4,
3133 };
3134 
3135 /**
3136  * enum nl80211_mpath_info - mesh path information
3137  *
3138  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO when getting
3139  * information about a mesh path.
3140  *
3141  * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3142  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: number of queued frames for this destination
3143  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN: destination sequence number
3144  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC: metric (cost) of this mesh path
3145  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: expiration time for the path, in msec from now
3146  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: mesh path flags, enumerated in
3147  * 	&enum nl80211_mpath_flags;
3148  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: total path discovery timeout, in msec
3149  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: mesh path discovery retries
3150  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX: highest mesh path information attribute number
3151  *	currently defind
3152  * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3153  */
3154 enum nl80211_mpath_info {
3155 	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID,
3156 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN,
3157 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN,
3158 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC,
3159 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME,
3160 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS,
3161 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
3162 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES,
3163 
3164 	/* keep last */
3165 	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3166 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3167 };
3168 
3169 /**
3170  * enum nl80211_band_attr - band attributes
3171  * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3172  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS: supported frequencies in this band,
3173  *	an array of nested frequency attributes
3174  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES: supported bitrates in this band,
3175  *	an array of nested bitrate attributes
3176  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET: 16-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
3177  *	defined in 802.11n
3178  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA: HT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
3179  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR: A-MPDU factor, as in 11n
3180  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY: A-MPDU density, as in 11n
3181  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET: 32-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
3182  *	defined in 802.11ac
3183  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA: VHT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
3184  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
3185  * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3186  */
3187 enum nl80211_band_attr {
3188 	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID,
3189 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS,
3190 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES,
3191 
3192 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET,
3193 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA,
3194 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR,
3195 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY,
3196 
3197 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET,
3198 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA,
3199 
3200 	/* keep last */
3201 	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3202 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3203 };
3204 
3205 #define NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA
3206 
3207 /**
3208  * enum nl80211_wmm_rule - regulatory wmm rule
3209  *
3210  * @__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3211  * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN: Minimum contention window slot.
3212  * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX: Maximum contention window slot.
3213  * @NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN: Arbitration Inter Frame Space.
3214  * @NL80211_WMMR_TXOP: Maximum allowed tx operation time.
3215  * @nl80211_WMMR_MAX: highest possible wmm rule.
3216  * @__NL80211_WMMR_LAST: Internal use.
3217  */
3218 enum nl80211_wmm_rule {
3219 	__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID,
3220 	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN,
3221 	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX,
3222 	NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN,
3223 	NL80211_WMMR_TXOP,
3224 
3225 	/* keep last */
3226 	__NL80211_WMMR_LAST,
3227 	NL80211_WMMR_MAX = __NL80211_WMMR_LAST - 1
3228 };
3229 
3230 /**
3231  * enum nl80211_frequency_attr - frequency attributes
3232  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3233  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ: Frequency in MHz
3234  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED: Channel is disabled in current
3235  *	regulatory domain.
3236  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation
3237  * 	are permitted on this channel, this includes sending probe
3238  * 	requests, or modes of operation that require beaconing.
3239  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR: Radar detection is mandatory
3240  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3241  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER: Maximum transmission power in mBm
3242  *	(100 * dBm).
3243  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE: current state for DFS
3244  *	(enum nl80211_dfs_state)
3245  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME: time in miliseconds for how long
3246  *	this channel is in this DFS state.
3247  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS: HT40- isn't possible with this
3248  *	channel as the control channel
3249  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS: HT40+ isn't possible with this
3250  *	channel as the control channel
3251  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ: any 80 MHz channel using this channel
3252  *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible,
3253  *	this includes 80+80 channels
3254  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ: any 160 MHz (but not 80+80) channel
3255  *	using this channel as the primary or any of the secondary channels
3256  *	isn't possible
3257  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
3258  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY: Only indoor use is permitted on this
3259  *	channel. A channel that has the INDOOR_ONLY attribute can only be
3260  *	used when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating in
3261  *	an indoor surroundings, i.e., it is connected to AC power (and not
3262  *	through portable DC inverters) or is under the control of a master
3263  *	that is acting as an AP and is connected to AC power.
3264  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT: IR operation is allowed on this
3265  *	channel if it's connected concurrently to a BSS on the same channel on
3266  *	the 2 GHz band or to a channel in the same UNII band (on the 5 GHz
3267  *	band), and IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR is not set. Instantiating a GO or TDLS
3268  *	off-channel on a channel that has the IR_CONCURRENT attribute set can be
3269  *	done when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating under
3270  *	the guidance of an authorized master, i.e., setting up a GO or TDLS
3271  *	off-channel while the device is also connected to an AP with DFS and
3272  *	radar detection on the UNII band (it is up to user-space, i.e.,
3273  *	wpa_supplicant to perform the required verifications). Using this
3274  *	attribute for IR is disallowed for master interfaces (IBSS, AP).
3275  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz operation is not allowed
3276  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3277  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz operation is not allowed
3278  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3279  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM: this channel has wmm limitations.
3280  *	This is a nested attribute that contains the wmm limitation per AC.
3281  *	(see &enum nl80211_wmm_rule)
3282  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX: highest frequency attribute number
3283  *	currently defined
3284  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3285  *
3286  * See https://apps.fcc.gov/eas/comments/GetPublishedDocument.html?id=327&tn=528122
3287  * for more information on the FCC description of the relaxations allowed
3288  * by NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY and
3289  * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT.
3290  */
3291 enum nl80211_frequency_attr {
3292 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID,
3293 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ,
3294 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED,
3295 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR,
3296 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS,
3297 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR,
3298 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER,
3299 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE,
3300 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME,
3301 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS,
3302 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS,
3303 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ,
3304 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ,
3305 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
3306 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY,
3307 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT,
3308 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ,
3309 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ,
3310 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM,
3311 
3312 	/* keep last */
3313 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3314 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3315 };
3316 
3317 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER
3318 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
3319 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
3320 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
3321 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_GO_CONCURRENT \
3322 					NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
3323 
3324 /**
3325  * enum nl80211_bitrate_attr - bitrate attributes
3326  * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3327  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE: Bitrate in units of 100 kbps
3328  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE: Short preamble supported
3329  *	in 2.4 GHz band.
3330  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX: highest bitrate attribute number
3331  *	currently defined
3332  * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3333  */
3334 enum nl80211_bitrate_attr {
3335 	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID,
3336 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE,
3337 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE,
3338 
3339 	/* keep last */
3340 	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3341 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3342 };
3343 
3344 /**
3345  * enum nl80211_initiator - Indicates the initiator of a reg domain request
3346  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE: Core queried CRDA for a dynamic world
3347  * 	regulatory domain.
3348  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER: User asked the wireless core to set the
3349  * 	regulatory domain.
3350  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER: a wireless drivers has hinted to the
3351  * 	wireless core it thinks its knows the regulatory domain we should be in.
3352  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE: the wireless core has received an
3353  * 	802.11 country information element with regulatory information it
3354  * 	thinks we should consider. cfg80211 only processes the country
3355  *	code from the IE, and relies on the regulatory domain information
3356  *	structure passed by userspace (CRDA) from our wireless-regdb.
3357  *	If a channel is enabled but the country code indicates it should
3358  *	be disabled we disable the channel and re-enable it upon disassociation.
3359  */
3360 enum nl80211_reg_initiator {
3361 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE,
3362 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER,
3363 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER,
3364 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE,
3365 };
3366 
3367 /**
3368  * enum nl80211_reg_type - specifies the type of regulatory domain
3369  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY: the regulatory domain set is one that pertains
3370  *	to a specific country. When this is set you can count on the
3371  *	ISO / IEC 3166 alpha2 country code being valid.
3372  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD: the regulatory set domain is the world regulatory
3373  * 	domain.
3374  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD: the regulatory domain set is a custom
3375  * 	driver specific world regulatory domain. These do not apply system-wide
3376  * 	and are only applicable to the individual devices which have requested
3377  * 	them to be applied.
3378  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION: the regulatory domain set is the product
3379  *	of an intersection between two regulatory domains -- the previously
3380  *	set regulatory domain on the system and the last accepted regulatory
3381  *	domain request to be processed.
3382  */
3383 enum nl80211_reg_type {
3384 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY,
3385 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD,
3386 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD,
3387 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION,
3388 };
3389 
3390 /**
3391  * enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr - regulatory rule attributes
3392  * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3393  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS: a set of flags which specify additional
3394  * 	considerations for a given frequency range. These are the
3395  * 	&enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags.
3396  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START: starting frequencry for the regulatory
3397  * 	rule in KHz. This is not a center of frequency but an actual regulatory
3398  * 	band edge.
3399  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END: ending frequency for the regulatory rule
3400  * 	in KHz. This is not a center a frequency but an actual regulatory
3401  * 	band edge.
3402  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW: maximum allowed bandwidth for this
3403  *	frequency range, in KHz.
3404  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN: the maximum allowed antenna gain
3405  * 	for a given frequency range. The value is in mBi (100 * dBi).
3406  * 	If you don't have one then don't send this.
3407  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP: the maximum allowed EIRP for
3408  * 	a given frequency range. The value is in mBm (100 * dBm).
3409  * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
3410  *	If not present or 0 default CAC time will be used.
3411  * @NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX: highest regulatory rule attribute number
3412  *	currently defined
3413  * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3414  */
3415 enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr {
3416 	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID,
3417 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS,
3418 
3419 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START,
3420 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END,
3421 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW,
3422 
3423 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN,
3424 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP,
3425 
3426 	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
3427 
3428 	/* keep last */
3429 	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3430 	NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3431 };
3432 
3433 /**
3434  * enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr - scheduled scan match attributes
3435  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3436  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID: SSID to be used for matching,
3437  *	only report BSS with matching SSID.
3438  *	(This cannot be used together with BSSID.)
3439  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI: RSSI threshold (in dBm) for reporting a
3440  *	BSS in scan results. Filtering is turned off if not specified. Note that
3441  *	if this attribute is in a match set of its own, then it is treated as
3442  *	the default value for all matchsets with an SSID, rather than being a
3443  *	matchset of its own without an RSSI filter. This is due to problems with
3444  *	how this API was implemented in the past. Also, due to the same problem,
3445  *	the only way to create a matchset with only an RSSI filter (with this
3446  *	attribute) is if there's only a single matchset with the RSSI attribute.
3447  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI: Flag indicating whether
3448  *	%NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI to be used as absolute RSSI or
3449  *	relative to current bss's RSSI.
3450  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
3451  *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
3452  *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
3453  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
3454  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID: BSSID to be used for matching
3455  *	(this cannot be used together with SSID).
3456  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest scheduled scan filter
3457  *	attribute number currently defined
3458  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3459  */
3460 enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr {
3461 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID,
3462 
3463 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID,
3464 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI,
3465 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI,
3466 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
3467 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID,
3468 
3469 	/* keep last */
3470 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3471 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX =
3472 		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3473 };
3474 
3475 /* only for backward compatibility */
3476 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_SSID NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID
3477 
3478 /**
3479  * enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags - regulatory rule flags
3480  *
3481  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM: OFDM modulation not allowed
3482  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK: CCK modulation not allowed
3483  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR: indoor operation not allowed
3484  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR: outdoor operation not allowed
3485  * @NL80211_RRF_DFS: DFS support is required to be used
3486  * @NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Point links
3487  * @NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Multi Point links
3488  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation are allowed,
3489  * 	this includes probe requests or modes of operation that require
3490  * 	beaconing.
3491  * @NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW: maximum available bandwidth should be calculated
3492  *	base on contiguous rules and wider channels will be allowed to cross
3493  *	multiple contiguous/overlapping frequency ranges.
3494  * @NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
3495  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS: channels can't be used in HT40- operation
3496  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS: channels can't be used in HT40+ operation
3497  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ: 80MHz operation not allowed
3498  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ: 160MHz operation not allowed
3499  */
3500 enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags {
3501 	NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM		= 1<<0,
3502 	NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK		= 1<<1,
3503 	NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR		= 1<<2,
3504 	NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR		= 1<<3,
3505 	NL80211_RRF_DFS			= 1<<4,
3506 	NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY		= 1<<5,
3507 	NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY		= 1<<6,
3508 	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		= 1<<7,
3509 	__NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		= 1<<8,
3510 	NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW		= 1<<11,
3511 	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<12,
3512 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<13,
3513 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS		= 1<<14,
3514 	NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<15,
3515 	NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ		= 1<<16,
3516 };
3517 
3518 #define NL80211_RRF_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
3519 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
3520 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
3521 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40		(NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS |\
3522 					 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS)
3523 #define NL80211_RRF_GO_CONCURRENT	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT
3524 
3525 /* For backport compatibility with older userspace */
3526 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR_ALL		(NL80211_RRF_NO_IR | __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS)
3527 
3528 /**
3529  * enum nl80211_dfs_regions - regulatory DFS regions
3530  *
3531  * @NL80211_DFS_UNSET: Country has no DFS master region specified
3532  * @NL80211_DFS_FCC: Country follows DFS master rules from FCC
3533  * @NL80211_DFS_ETSI: Country follows DFS master rules from ETSI
3534  * @NL80211_DFS_JP: Country follows DFS master rules from JP/MKK/Telec
3535  */
3536 enum nl80211_dfs_regions {
3537 	NL80211_DFS_UNSET	= 0,
3538 	NL80211_DFS_FCC		= 1,
3539 	NL80211_DFS_ETSI	= 2,
3540 	NL80211_DFS_JP		= 3,
3541 };
3542 
3543 /**
3544  * enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type - type of user regulatory hint
3545  *
3546  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER: a user sent the hint. This is always
3547  *	assumed if the attribute is not set.
3548  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE: the hint comes from a cellular
3549  *	base station. Device drivers that have been tested to work
3550  *	properly to support this type of hint can enable these hints
3551  *	by setting the NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS feature
3552  *	capability on the struct wiphy. The wireless core will
3553  *	ignore all cell base station hints until at least one device
3554  *	present has been registered with the wireless core that
3555  *	has listed NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS as a
3556  *	supported feature.
3557  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR: a user sent an hint indicating that the
3558  *	platform is operating in an indoor environment.
3559  */
3560 enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type {
3561 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER	= 0,
3562 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE = 1,
3563 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR    = 2,
3564 };
3565 
3566 /**
3567  * enum nl80211_survey_info - survey information
3568  *
3569  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO
3570  * when getting information about a survey.
3571  *
3572  * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3573  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY: center frequency of channel
3574  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE: noise level of channel (u8, dBm)
3575  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
3576  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME: amount of time (in ms) that the radio
3577  *	was turned on (on channel or globally)
3578  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: amount of the time the primary
3579  *	channel was sensed busy (either due to activity or energy detect)
3580  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: amount of time the extension
3581  *	channel was sensed busy
3582  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: amount of time the radio spent
3583  *	receiving data (on channel or globally)
3584  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: amount of time the radio spent
3585  *	transmitting data (on channel or globally)
3586  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: time the radio spent for scan
3587  *	(on this channel or globally)
3588  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3589  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX: highest survey info attribute number
3590  *	currently defined
3591  * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3592  */
3593 enum nl80211_survey_info {
3594 	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID,
3595 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY,
3596 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE,
3597 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE,
3598 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME,
3599 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY,
3600 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY,
3601 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX,
3602 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX,
3603 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN,
3604 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD,
3605 
3606 	/* keep last */
3607 	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3608 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3609 };
3610 
3611 /* keep old names for compatibility */
3612 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME
3613 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_BUSY		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY
3614 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_EXT_BUSY	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY
3615 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_RX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX
3616 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_TX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX
3617 
3618 /**
3619  * enum nl80211_mntr_flags - monitor configuration flags
3620  *
3621  * Monitor configuration flags.
3622  *
3623  * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID: reserved
3624  *
3625  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
3626  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
3627  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
3628  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
3629  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing.
3630  *	overrides all other flags.
3631  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE: use the configured MAC address
3632  *	and ACK incoming unicast packets.
3633  *
3634  * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3635  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX: highest possible monitor flag
3636  */
3637 enum nl80211_mntr_flags {
3638 	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
3639 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
3640 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
3641 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
3642 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
3643 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
3644 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
3645 
3646 	/* keep last */
3647 	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
3648 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
3649 };
3650 
3651 /**
3652  * enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode - mesh power save modes
3653  *
3654  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN: The mesh power mode of the mesh STA is
3655  *	not known or has not been set yet.
3656  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE: Active mesh power mode. The mesh STA is
3657  *	in Awake state all the time.
3658  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP: Light sleep mode. The mesh STA will
3659  *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but will wake up for
3660  *	neighbor's beacons.
3661  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP: Deep sleep mode. The mesh STA will
3662  *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but may not wake up
3663  *	for neighbor's beacons.
3664  *
3665  * @__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - internal use
3666  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX - highest possible power save level
3667  */
3668 
3669 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode {
3670 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN,
3671 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE,
3672 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP,
3673 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP,
3674 
3675 	__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST,
3676 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - 1
3677 };
3678 
3679 /**
3680  * enum nl80211_meshconf_params - mesh configuration parameters
3681  *
3682  * Mesh configuration parameters. These can be changed while the mesh is
3683  * active.
3684  *
3685  * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID: internal use
3686  *
3687  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial retry timeout in
3688  *	millisecond units, used by the Peer Link Open message
3689  *
3690  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial confirm timeout, in
3691  *	millisecond units, used by the peer link management to close a peer link
3692  *
3693  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT: specifies the holding timeout, in
3694  *	millisecond units
3695  *
3696  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS: maximum number of peer links allowed
3697  *	on this mesh interface
3698  *
3699  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES: specifies the maximum number of peer link
3700  *	open retries that can be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a
3701  *	mesh
3702  *
3703  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a source mesh
3704  *	point.
3705  *
3706  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS: whether we should automatically open
3707  *	peer links when we detect compatible mesh peers. Disabled if
3708  *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM or @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE are
3709  *	set.
3710  *
3711  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES: the number of action frames
3712  *	containing a PREQ that an MP can send to a particular destination (path
3713  *	target)
3714  *
3715  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME: how frequently to refresh mesh paths
3716  *	(in milliseconds)
3717  *
3718  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: minimum length of time to wait
3719  *	until giving up on a path discovery (in milliseconds)
3720  *
3721  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for which mesh
3722  *	points receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from
3723  *	the root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
3724  *
3725  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
3726  *	TUs) during which an MP can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
3727  *	reference element
3728  *
3729  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME: The interval of time (in TUs)
3730  *	that it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the
3731  *	mesh
3732  *
3733  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE: whether root mode is enabled or not
3734  *
3735  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a
3736  *	source mesh point for path selection elements.
3737  *
3738  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL:  The interval of time (in TUs) between
3739  *	root announcements are transmitted.
3740  *
3741  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS: Advertise that this mesh station has
3742  *	access to a broader network beyond the MBSS.  This is done via Root
3743  *	Announcement frames.
3744  *
3745  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
3746  *	TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a
3747  *	PERR element.
3748  *
3749  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING: set Mesh STA as forwarding or non-forwarding
3750  *	or forwarding entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
3751  *
3752  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This specifies the
3753  *	threshold for average signal strength of candidate station to establish
3754  *	a peer link.
3755  *
3756  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR: maximum number of neighbors
3757  *	to synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
3758  *	(see 11C.12.2.2)
3759  *
3760  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE: set mesh HT protection mode.
3761  *
3762  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh configuration attribute
3763  *
3764  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for
3765  *	which mesh STAs receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding
3766  *	information to the root mesh STA to be valid.
3767  *
3768  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between
3769  *	proactive PREQs are transmitted.
3770  *
3771  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time
3772  *	(in TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame
3773  *	containing a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
3774  *
3775  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE: Default mesh power mode for new peer links.
3776  *	type &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode (u32)
3777  *
3778  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW: awake window duration (in TUs)
3779  *
3780  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've
3781  *	established peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then
3782  *	remove it from the STA's list of peers. You may set this to 0 to disable
3783  *	the removal of the STA. Default is 30 minutes.
3784  *
3785  * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3786  */
3787 enum nl80211_meshconf_params {
3788 	__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID,
3789 	NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT,
3790 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT,
3791 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT,
3792 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS,
3793 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES,
3794 	NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL,
3795 	NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS,
3796 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES,
3797 	NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME,
3798 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
3799 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT,
3800 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL,
3801 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME,
3802 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE,
3803 	NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL,
3804 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL,
3805 	NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS,
3806 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL,
3807 	NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING,
3808 	NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD,
3809 	NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR,
3810 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE,
3811 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT,
3812 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL,
3813 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL,
3814 	NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE,
3815 	NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW,
3816 	NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT,
3817 
3818 	/* keep last */
3819 	__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3820 	NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3821 };
3822 
3823 /**
3824  * enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params - mesh setup parameters
3825  *
3826  * Mesh setup parameters.  These are used to start/join a mesh and cannot be
3827  * changed while the mesh is active.
3828  *
3829  * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID: Internal use
3830  *
3831  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL: Enable this option to use a
3832  *	vendor specific path selection algorithm or disable it to use the
3833  *	default HWMP.
3834  *
3835  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC: Enable this option to use a
3836  *	vendor specific path metric or disable it to use the default Airtime
3837  *	metric.
3838  *
3839  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE: Information elements for this mesh, for instance, a
3840  *	robust security network ie, or a vendor specific information element
3841  *	that vendors will use to identify the path selection methods and
3842  *	metrics in use.
3843  *
3844  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH: Enable this option if an authentication
3845  *	daemon will be authenticating mesh candidates.
3846  *
3847  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE: Enable this option if an authentication
3848  *	daemon will be securing peer link frames.  AMPE is a secured version of
3849  *	Mesh Peering Management (MPM) and is implemented with the assistance of
3850  *	a userspace daemon.  When this flag is set, the kernel will send peer
3851  *	management frames to a userspace daemon that will implement AMPE
3852  *	functionality (security capabilities selection, key confirmation, and
3853  *	key management).  When the flag is unset (default), the kernel can
3854  *	autonomously complete (unsecured) mesh peering without the need of a
3855  *	userspace daemon.
3856  *
3857  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC: Enable this option to use a
3858  *	vendor specific synchronization method or disable it to use the default
3859  *	neighbor offset synchronization
3860  *
3861  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM: Enable this option if userspace will
3862  *	implement an MPM which handles peer allocation and state.
3863  *
3864  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL: Inform the kernel of the authentication
3865  *	method (u8, as defined in IEEE 8.4.2.100.6, e.g. 0x1 for SAE).
3866  *	Default is no authentication method required.
3867  *
3868  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh setup attribute number
3869  *
3870  * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal use
3871  */
3872 enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params {
3873 	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID,
3874 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL,
3875 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC,
3876 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE,
3877 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
3878 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE,
3879 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC,
3880 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM,
3881 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL,
3882 
3883 	/* keep last */
3884 	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3885 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3886 };
3887 
3888 /**
3889  * enum nl80211_txq_attr - TX queue parameter attributes
3890  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID: Attribute number 0 is reserved
3891  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC: AC identifier (NL80211_AC_*)
3892  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning
3893  *	disabled
3894  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN: Minimum contention window [a value of the form
3895  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
3896  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX: Maximum contention window [a value of the form
3897  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
3898  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
3899  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
3900  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX: Maximum TXQ attribute number
3901  */
3902 enum nl80211_txq_attr {
3903 	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID,
3904 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC,
3905 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP,
3906 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN,
3907 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX,
3908 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS,
3909 
3910 	/* keep last */
3911 	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3912 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3913 };
3914 
3915 enum nl80211_ac {
3916 	NL80211_AC_VO,
3917 	NL80211_AC_VI,
3918 	NL80211_AC_BE,
3919 	NL80211_AC_BK,
3920 	NL80211_NUM_ACS
3921 };
3922 
3923 /* backward compat */
3924 #define NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_QUEUE	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC
3925 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VO	NL80211_AC_VO
3926 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VI	NL80211_AC_VI
3927 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BE	NL80211_AC_BE
3928 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BK	NL80211_AC_BK
3929 
3930 /**
3931  * enum nl80211_channel_type - channel type
3932  * @NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
3933  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT20: 20 MHz HT channel
3934  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
3935  *	below the control channel
3936  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
3937  *	above the control channel
3938  */
3939 enum nl80211_channel_type {
3940 	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT,
3941 	NL80211_CHAN_HT20,
3942 	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS,
3943 	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS
3944 };
3945 
3946 /**
3947  * enum nl80211_chan_width - channel width definitions
3948  *
3949  * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH
3950  * attribute.
3951  *
3952  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
3953  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 20 MHz HT channel
3954  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 40 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
3955  *	attribute must be provided as well
3956  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80: 80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
3957  *	attribute must be provided as well
3958  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80: 80+80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
3959  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 attributes must be provided as well
3960  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160: 160 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
3961  *	attribute must be provided as well
3962  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 5 MHz OFDM channel
3963  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 10 MHz OFDM channel
3964  */
3965 enum nl80211_chan_width {
3966 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT,
3967 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
3968 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40,
3969 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80,
3970 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80,
3971 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160,
3972 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
3973 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
3974 };
3975 
3976 /**
3977  * enum nl80211_bss_scan_width - control channel width for a BSS
3978  *
3979  * These values are used with the %NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH attribute.
3980  *
3981  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20: control channel is 20 MHz wide or compatible
3982  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10: control channel is 10 MHz wide
3983  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5: control channel is 5 MHz wide
3984  */
3985 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width {
3986 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
3987 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
3988 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
3989 };
3990 
3991 /**
3992  * enum nl80211_bss - netlink attributes for a BSS
3993  *
3994  * @__NL80211_BSS_INVALID: invalid
3995  * @NL80211_BSS_BSSID: BSSID of the BSS (6 octets)
3996  * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY: frequency in MHz (u32)
3997  * @NL80211_BSS_TSF: TSF of the received probe response/beacon (u64)
3998  *	(if @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA is present then this is known to be
3999  *	from a probe response, otherwise it may be from the same beacon
4000  *	that the NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF will be from)
4001  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval of the (I)BSS (u16)
4002  * @NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY: capability field (CPU order, u16)
4003  * @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS: binary attribute containing the
4004  *	raw information elements from the probe response/beacon (bin);
4005  *	if the %NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES attribute is present and the data is
4006  *	different then the IEs here are from a Probe Response frame; otherwise
4007  *	they are from a Beacon frame.
4008  *	However, if the driver does not indicate the source of the IEs, these
4009  *	IEs may be from either frame subtype.
4010  *	If present, the @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA attribute indicates that the
4011  *	data here is known to be from a probe response, without any heuristics.
4012  * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM: signal strength of probe response/beacon
4013  *	in mBm (100 * dBm) (s32)
4014  * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: signal strength of the probe response/beacon
4015  *	in unspecified units, scaled to 0..100 (u8)
4016  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS: status, if this BSS is "used"
4017  * @NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO: age of this BSS entry in ms
4018  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES: binary attribute containing the raw information
4019  *	elements from a Beacon frame (bin); not present if no Beacon frame has
4020  *	yet been received
4021  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH: channel width of the control channel
4022  *	(u32, enum nl80211_bss_scan_width)
4023  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF: TSF of the last received beacon (u64)
4024  *	(not present if no beacon frame has been received yet)
4025  * @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA: the data in @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS and
4026  *	@NL80211_BSS_TSF is known to be from a probe response (flag attribute)
4027  * @NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp when this entry
4028  *	was last updated by a received frame. The value is expected to be
4029  *	accurate to about 10ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
4030  * @NL80211_BSS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
4031  * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF: the time at the start of reception of the first
4032  *	octet of the timestamp field of the last beacon/probe received for
4033  *	this BSS. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified by
4034  *	@NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID. (u64).
4035  * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID: the BSS according to which @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF
4036  *	is set.
4037  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last BSS update.
4038  *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm),
4039  *	using the nesting index as the antenna number.
4040  * @__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST: internal
4041  * @NL80211_BSS_MAX: highest BSS attribute
4042  */
4043 enum nl80211_bss {
4044 	__NL80211_BSS_INVALID,
4045 	NL80211_BSS_BSSID,
4046 	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY,
4047 	NL80211_BSS_TSF,
4048 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL,
4049 	NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY,
4050 	NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS,
4051 	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM,
4052 	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
4053 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS,
4054 	NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO,
4055 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES,
4056 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH,
4057 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF,
4058 	NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA,
4059 	NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME,
4060 	NL80211_BSS_PAD,
4061 	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
4062 	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID,
4063 	NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
4064 
4065 	/* keep last */
4066 	__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST,
4067 	NL80211_BSS_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST - 1
4068 };
4069 
4070 /**
4071  * enum nl80211_bss_status - BSS "status"
4072  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED: Authenticated with this BSS.
4073  *	Note that this is no longer used since cfg80211 no longer
4074  *	keeps track of whether or not authentication was done with
4075  *	a given BSS.
4076  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED: Associated with this BSS.
4077  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED: Joined to this IBSS.
4078  *
4079  * The BSS status is a BSS attribute in scan dumps, which
4080  * indicates the status the interface has wrt. this BSS.
4081  */
4082 enum nl80211_bss_status {
4083 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED,
4084 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED,
4085 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED,
4086 };
4087 
4088 /**
4089  * enum nl80211_auth_type - AuthenticationType
4090  *
4091  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM: Open System authentication
4092  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY: Shared Key authentication (WEP only)
4093  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT: Fast BSS Transition (IEEE 802.11r)
4094  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP: Network EAP (some Cisco APs and mainly LEAP)
4095  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE: Simultaneous authentication of equals
4096  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key
4097  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key with PFS
4098  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK: Fast Initial Link Setup public key
4099  * @__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM: internal
4100  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX: maximum valid auth algorithm
4101  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC: determine automatically (if necessary by
4102  *	trying multiple times); this is invalid in netlink -- leave out
4103  *	the attribute for this on CONNECT commands.
4104  */
4105 enum nl80211_auth_type {
4106 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM,
4107 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY,
4108 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT,
4109 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP,
4110 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE,
4111 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK,
4112 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS,
4113 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK,
4114 
4115 	/* keep last */
4116 	__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM,
4117 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX = __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM - 1,
4118 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC
4119 };
4120 
4121 /**
4122  * enum nl80211_key_type - Key Type
4123  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP: Group (broadcast/multicast) key
4124  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE: Pairwise (unicast/individual) key
4125  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY: PeerKey (DLS)
4126  * @NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES: number of defined key types
4127  */
4128 enum nl80211_key_type {
4129 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP,
4130 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE,
4131 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY,
4132 
4133 	NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES
4134 };
4135 
4136 /**
4137  * enum nl80211_mfp - Management frame protection state
4138  * @NL80211_MFP_NO: Management frame protection not used
4139  * @NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED: Management frame protection required
4140  * @NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL: Management frame protection is optional
4141  */
4142 enum nl80211_mfp {
4143 	NL80211_MFP_NO,
4144 	NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED,
4145 	NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL,
4146 };
4147 
4148 enum nl80211_wpa_versions {
4149 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_1 = 1 << 0,
4150 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_2 = 1 << 1,
4151 };
4152 
4153 /**
4154  * enum nl80211_key_default_types - key default types
4155  * @__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID: invalid
4156  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST: key should be used as default
4157  *	unicast key
4158  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST: key should be used as default
4159  *	multicast key
4160  * @NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: number of default types
4161  */
4162 enum nl80211_key_default_types {
4163 	__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID,
4164 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST,
4165 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST,
4166 
4167 	NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES
4168 };
4169 
4170 /**
4171  * enum nl80211_key_attributes - key attributes
4172  * @__NL80211_KEY_INVALID: invalid
4173  * @NL80211_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
4174  *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
4175  *	keys
4176  * @NL80211_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
4177  * @NL80211_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
4178  *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
4179  * @NL80211_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
4180  *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
4181  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT: flag indicating default key
4182  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: flag indicating default management key
4183  * @NL80211_KEY_TYPE: the key type from enum nl80211_key_type, if not
4184  *	specified the default depends on whether a MAC address was
4185  *	given with the command using the key or not (u32)
4186  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
4187  *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
4188  *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
4189  * @__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST: internal
4190  * @NL80211_KEY_MAX: highest key attribute
4191  */
4192 enum nl80211_key_attributes {
4193 	__NL80211_KEY_INVALID,
4194 	NL80211_KEY_DATA,
4195 	NL80211_KEY_IDX,
4196 	NL80211_KEY_CIPHER,
4197 	NL80211_KEY_SEQ,
4198 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT,
4199 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
4200 	NL80211_KEY_TYPE,
4201 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
4202 
4203 	/* keep last */
4204 	__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST,
4205 	NL80211_KEY_MAX = __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST - 1
4206 };
4207 
4208 /**
4209  * enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes - TX rate set attributes
4210  * @__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID: invalid
4211  * @NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY: Legacy (non-MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
4212  *	in an array of rates as defined in IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 (u8 values with
4213  *	1 = 500 kbps) but without the IE length restriction (at most
4214  *	%NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES in a single array).
4215  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HT: HT (MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
4216  *	in an array of MCS numbers.
4217  * @NL80211_TXRATE_VHT: VHT rates allowed for TX rate selection,
4218  *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_vht
4219  * @NL80211_TXRATE_GI: configure GI, see &enum nl80211_txrate_gi
4220  * @__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST: internal
4221  * @NL80211_TXRATE_MAX: highest TX rate attribute
4222  */
4223 enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes {
4224 	__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID,
4225 	NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY,
4226 	NL80211_TXRATE_HT,
4227 	NL80211_TXRATE_VHT,
4228 	NL80211_TXRATE_GI,
4229 
4230 	/* keep last */
4231 	__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST,
4232 	NL80211_TXRATE_MAX = __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST - 1
4233 };
4234 
4235 #define NL80211_TXRATE_MCS NL80211_TXRATE_HT
4236 #define NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX		8
4237 
4238 /**
4239  * struct nl80211_txrate_vht - VHT MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
4240  * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
4241  */
4242 struct nl80211_txrate_vht {
4243 	__u16 mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
4244 };
4245 
4246 enum nl80211_txrate_gi {
4247 	NL80211_TXRATE_DEFAULT_GI,
4248 	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_SGI,
4249 	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_LGI,
4250 };
4251 
4252 /**
4253  * enum nl80211_band - Frequency band
4254  * @NL80211_BAND_2GHZ: 2.4 GHz ISM band
4255  * @NL80211_BAND_5GHZ: around 5 GHz band (4.9 - 5.7 GHz)
4256  * @NL80211_BAND_60GHZ: around 60 GHz band (58.32 - 64.80 GHz)
4257  * @NUM_NL80211_BANDS: number of bands, avoid using this in userspace
4258  *	since newer kernel versions may support more bands
4259  */
4260 enum nl80211_band {
4261 	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ,
4262 	NL80211_BAND_5GHZ,
4263 	NL80211_BAND_60GHZ,
4264 
4265 	NUM_NL80211_BANDS,
4266 };
4267 
4268 /**
4269  * enum nl80211_ps_state - powersave state
4270  * @NL80211_PS_DISABLED: powersave is disabled
4271  * @NL80211_PS_ENABLED: powersave is enabled
4272  */
4273 enum nl80211_ps_state {
4274 	NL80211_PS_DISABLED,
4275 	NL80211_PS_ENABLED,
4276 };
4277 
4278 /**
4279  * enum nl80211_attr_cqm - connection quality monitor attributes
4280  * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID: invalid
4281  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This value specifies
4282  *	the threshold for the RSSI level at which an event will be sent. Zero
4283  *	to disable.  Alternatively, if %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST is
4284  *	set, multiple values can be supplied as a low-to-high sorted array of
4285  *	threshold values in dBm.  Events will be sent when the RSSI value
4286  *	crosses any of the thresholds.
4287  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST: RSSI hysteresis in dBm. This value specifies
4288  *	the minimum amount the RSSI level must change after an event before a
4289  *	new event may be issued (to reduce effects of RSSI oscillation).
4290  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT: RSSI threshold event
4291  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT: a u32 value indicating that this many
4292  *	consecutive packets were not acknowledged by the peer
4293  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE: TX error rate in %. Minimum % of TX failures
4294  *	during the given %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before an
4295  *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM with reported %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE and
4296  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS is generated.
4297  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS: number of attempted packets in a given
4298  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE is
4299  *	checked.
4300  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL: interval in seconds. Specifies the periodic
4301  *	interval in which %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS and
4302  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE must be satisfied before generating an
4303  *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM. Set to 0 to turn off TX error reporting.
4304  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: flag attribute that's set in a beacon
4305  *	loss event
4306  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL: the RSSI value in dBm that triggered the
4307  *	RSSI threshold event.
4308  * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST: internal
4309  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX: highest key attribute
4310  */
4311 enum nl80211_attr_cqm {
4312 	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID,
4313 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD,
4314 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST,
4315 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT,
4316 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT,
4317 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE,
4318 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS,
4319 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL,
4320 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
4321 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL,
4322 
4323 	/* keep last */
4324 	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST,
4325 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST - 1
4326 };
4327 
4328 /**
4329  * enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event - RSSI threshold event
4330  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW: The RSSI level is lower than the
4331  *      configured threshold
4332  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH: The RSSI is higher than the
4333  *      configured threshold
4334  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: (reserved, never sent)
4335  */
4336 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event {
4337 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW,
4338 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH,
4339 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
4340 };
4341 
4342 
4343 /**
4344  * enum nl80211_tx_power_setting - TX power adjustment
4345  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine transmit power
4346  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED: limit TX power by the mBm parameter
4347  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED: fix TX power to the mBm parameter
4348  */
4349 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting {
4350 	NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC,
4351 	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED,
4352 	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED,
4353 };
4354 
4355 /**
4356  * enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr - packet pattern attribute
4357  * @__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
4358  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN: the pattern, values where the mask has
4359  *	a zero bit are ignored
4360  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK: pattern mask, must be long enough to have
4361  *	a bit for each byte in the pattern. The lowest-order bit corresponds
4362  *	to the first byte of the pattern, but the bytes of the pattern are
4363  *	in a little-endian-like format, i.e. the 9th byte of the pattern
4364  *	corresponds to the lowest-order bit in the second byte of the mask.
4365  *	For example: The match 00:xx:00:00:xx:00:00:00:00:xx:xx:xx (where
4366  *	xx indicates "don't care") would be represented by a pattern of
4367  *	twelve zero bytes, and a mask of "0xed,0x01".
4368  *	Note that the pattern matching is done as though frames were not
4369  *	802.11 frames but 802.3 frames, i.e. the frame is fully unpacked
4370  *	first (including SNAP header unpacking) and then matched.
4371  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET: packet offset, pattern is matched after
4372  *	these fixed number of bytes of received packet
4373  * @NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT: number of attributes
4374  * @MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT: max attribute number
4375  */
4376 enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr {
4377 	__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID,
4378 	NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK,
4379 	NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN,
4380 	NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET,
4381 
4382 	NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT,
4383 	MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT = NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT - 1,
4384 };
4385 
4386 /**
4387  * struct nl80211_pattern_support - packet pattern support information
4388  * @max_patterns: maximum number of patterns supported
4389  * @min_pattern_len: minimum length of each pattern
4390  * @max_pattern_len: maximum length of each pattern
4391  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
4392  *
4393  * This struct is carried in %NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN when
4394  * that is part of %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED or in
4395  * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN when that is part of
4396  * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the capability information given
4397  * by the kernel to userspace.
4398  */
4399 struct nl80211_pattern_support {
4400 	__u32 max_patterns;
4401 	__u32 min_pattern_len;
4402 	__u32 max_pattern_len;
4403 	__u32 max_pkt_offset;
4404 } __attribute__((packed));
4405 
4406 /* only for backward compatibility */
4407 #define __NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_INVALID __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID
4408 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_MASK NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
4409 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_PATTERN NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN
4410 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_OFFSET NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET
4411 #define NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT
4412 #define MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT
4413 #define nl80211_wowlan_pattern_support nl80211_pattern_support
4414 
4415 /**
4416  * enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers - WoWLAN trigger definitions
4417  * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
4418  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY: wake up on any activity, do not really put
4419  *	the chip into a special state -- works best with chips that have
4420  *	support for low-power operation already (flag)
4421  *	Note that this mode is incompatible with all of the others, if
4422  *	any others are even supported by the device.
4423  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT: wake up on disconnect, the way disconnect
4424  *	is detected is implementation-specific (flag)
4425  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT: wake up on magic packet (6x 0xff, followed
4426  *	by 16 repetitions of MAC addr, anywhere in payload) (flag)
4427  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN: wake up on the specified packet patterns
4428  *	which are passed in an array of nested attributes, each nested attribute
4429  *	defining a with attributes from &struct nl80211_wowlan_trig_pkt_pattern.
4430  *	Each pattern defines a wakeup packet. Packet offset is associated with
4431  *	each pattern which is used while matching the pattern. The matching is
4432  *	done on the MSDU, i.e. as though the packet was an 802.3 packet, so the
4433  *	pattern matching is done after the packet is converted to the MSDU.
4434  *
4435  *	In %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, it is a binary attribute
4436  *	carrying a &struct nl80211_pattern_support.
4437  *
4438  *	When reporting wakeup. it is a u32 attribute containing the 0-based
4439  *	index of the pattern that caused the wakeup, in the patterns passed
4440  *	to the kernel when configuring.
4441  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED: Not a real trigger, and cannot be
4442  *	used when setting, used only to indicate that GTK rekeying is supported
4443  *	by the device (flag)
4444  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: wake up on GTK rekey failure (if
4445  *	done by the device) (flag)
4446  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST: wake up on EAP Identity Request
4447  *	packet (flag)
4448  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: wake up on 4-way handshake (flag)
4449  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE: wake up when rfkill is released
4450  *	(on devices that have rfkill in the device) (flag)
4451  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211: For wakeup reporting only, contains
4452  *	the 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a deauth frame. The frame
4453  *	may be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN
4454  *	attribute contains the original length.
4455  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN: Original length of the 802.11
4456  *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211
4457  *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
4458  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023: For wakeup reporting only, contains the
4459  *	802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a magic packet. The frame may
4460  *	be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN attribute
4461  *	contains the original length.
4462  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN: Original length of the 802.3
4463  *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023
4464  *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
4465  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION: TCP connection wake, see DOC section
4466  *	"TCP connection wakeup" for more details. This is a nested attribute
4467  *	containing the exact information for establishing and keeping alive
4468  *	the TCP connection.
4469  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_WAKEUP_MATCH: For wakeup reporting only, the
4470  *	wakeup packet was received on the TCP connection
4471  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST: For wakeup reporting only, the
4472  *	TCP connection was lost or failed to be established
4473  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS: For wakeup reporting only,
4474  *	the TCP connection ran out of tokens to use for data to send to the
4475  *	service
4476  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT: wake up when a configured network
4477  *	is detected.  This is a nested attribute that contains the
4478  *	same attributes used with @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN.  It
4479  *	specifies how the scan is performed (e.g. the interval, the
4480  *	channels to scan and the initial delay) as well as the scan
4481  *	results that will trigger a wake (i.e. the matchsets).  This
4482  *	attribute is also sent in a response to
4483  *	@NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, indicating the number of match sets
4484  *	supported by the driver (u32).
4485  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS: nested attribute
4486  *	containing an array with information about what triggered the
4487  *	wake up.  If no elements are present in the array, it means
4488  *	that the information is not available.  If more than one
4489  *	element is present, it means that more than one match
4490  *	occurred.
4491  *	Each element in the array is a nested attribute that contains
4492  *	one optional %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute and one optional
4493  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES attribute.  At least one of
4494  *	these attributes must be present.  If
4495  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES contains more than one
4496  *	frequency, it means that the match occurred in more than one
4497  *	channel.
4498  * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: number of wake on wireless triggers
4499  * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: highest wowlan trigger attribute number
4500  *
4501  * These nested attributes are used to configure the wakeup triggers and
4502  * to report the wakeup reason(s).
4503  */
4504 enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers {
4505 	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID,
4506 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY,
4507 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT,
4508 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT,
4509 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN,
4510 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED,
4511 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE,
4512 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST,
4513 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE,
4514 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE,
4515 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211,
4516 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN,
4517 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023,
4518 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN,
4519 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION,
4520 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH,
4521 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST,
4522 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS,
4523 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT,
4524 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS,
4525 
4526 	/* keep last */
4527 	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG,
4528 	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG - 1
4529 };
4530 
4531 /**
4532  * DOC: TCP connection wakeup
4533  *
4534  * Some devices can establish a TCP connection in order to be woken up by a
4535  * packet coming in from outside their network segment, or behind NAT. If
4536  * configured, the device will establish a TCP connection to the given
4537  * service, and periodically send data to that service. The first data
4538  * packet is usually transmitted after SYN/ACK, also ACKing the SYN/ACK.
4539  * The data packets can optionally include a (little endian) sequence
4540  * number (in the TCP payload!) that is generated by the device, and, also
4541  * optionally, a token from a list of tokens. This serves as a keep-alive
4542  * with the service, and for NATed connections, etc.
4543  *
4544  * During this keep-alive period, the server doesn't send any data to the
4545  * client. When receiving data, it is compared against the wakeup pattern
4546  * (and mask) and if it matches, the host is woken up. Similarly, if the
4547  * connection breaks or cannot be established to start with, the host is
4548  * also woken up.
4549  *
4550  * Developer's note: ARP offload is required for this, otherwise TCP
4551  * response packets might not go through correctly.
4552  */
4553 
4554 /**
4555  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq - WoWLAN TCP data sequence
4556  * @start: starting value
4557  * @offset: offset of sequence number in packet
4558  * @len: length of the sequence value to write, 1 through 4
4559  *
4560  * Note: don't confuse with the TCP sequence number(s), this is for the
4561  * keepalive packet payload. The actual value is written into the packet
4562  * in little endian.
4563  */
4564 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq {
4565 	__u32 start, offset, len;
4566 };
4567 
4568 /**
4569  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token - WoWLAN TCP data token config
4570  * @offset: offset of token in packet
4571  * @len: length of each token
4572  * @token_stream: stream of data to be used for the tokens, the length must
4573  *	be a multiple of @len for this to make sense
4574  */
4575 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token {
4576 	__u32 offset, len;
4577 	__u8 token_stream[];
4578 };
4579 
4580 /**
4581  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature - data token features
4582  * @min_len: minimum token length
4583  * @max_len: maximum token length
4584  * @bufsize: total available token buffer size (max size of @token_stream)
4585  */
4586 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature {
4587 	__u32 min_len, max_len, bufsize;
4588 };
4589 
4590 /**
4591  * enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs - WoWLAN TCP connection parameters
4592  * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
4593  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4: source IPv4 address (in network byte order)
4594  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4: destination IPv4 address
4595  *	(in network byte order)
4596  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC: destination MAC address, this is given because
4597  *	route lookup when configured might be invalid by the time we suspend,
4598  *	and doing a route lookup when suspending is no longer possible as it
4599  *	might require ARP querying.
4600  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT: source port (u16); optional, if not given a
4601  *	socket and port will be allocated
4602  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT: destination port (u16)
4603  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD: data packet payload, at least one byte.
4604  *	For feature advertising, a u32 attribute holding the maximum length
4605  *	of the data payload.
4606  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ: data packet sequence configuration
4607  *	(if desired), a &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq. For feature
4608  *	advertising it is just a flag
4609  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN: data packet token configuration,
4610  *	see &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token and for advertising see
4611  *	&struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature.
4612  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL: data interval in seconds, maximum
4613  *	interval in feature advertising (u32)
4614  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD: wake packet payload, for advertising a
4615  *	u32 attribute holding the maximum length
4616  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK: Wake packet payload mask, not used for
4617  *	feature advertising. The mask works like @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
4618  *	but on the TCP payload only.
4619  * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: number of TCP attributes
4620  * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: highest attribute number
4621  */
4622 enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs {
4623 	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID,
4624 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4,
4625 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4,
4626 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC,
4627 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT,
4628 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT,
4629 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD,
4630 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ,
4631 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN,
4632 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL,
4633 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD,
4634 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK,
4635 
4636 	/* keep last */
4637 	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP,
4638 	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP - 1
4639 };
4640 
4641 /**
4642  * struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support - coalesce rule support information
4643  * @max_rules: maximum number of rules supported
4644  * @pat: packet pattern support information
4645  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
4646  *
4647  * This struct is carried in %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the
4648  * capability information given by the kernel to userspace.
4649  */
4650 struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support {
4651 	__u32 max_rules;
4652 	struct nl80211_pattern_support pat;
4653 	__u32 max_delay;
4654 } __attribute__((packed));
4655 
4656 /**
4657  * enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule - coalesce rule attribute
4658  * @__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
4659  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY: delay in msecs used for packet coalescing
4660  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION: condition for packet coalescence,
4661  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
4662  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN: packet offset, pattern is matched
4663  *	after these fixed number of bytes of received packet
4664  * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: number of attributes
4665  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX: max attribute number
4666  */
4667 enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule {
4668 	__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID,
4669 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY,
4670 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION,
4671 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN,
4672 
4673 	/* keep last */
4674 	NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
4675 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE - 1
4676 };
4677 
4678 /**
4679  * enum nl80211_coalesce_condition - coalesce rule conditions
4680  * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH: coalaesce Rx packets when patterns
4681  *	in a rule are matched.
4682  * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns
4683  *	in a rule are not matched.
4684  */
4685 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition {
4686 	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH,
4687 	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH
4688 };
4689 
4690 /**
4691  * enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs - limit attributes
4692  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC: (reserved)
4693  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX: maximum number of interfaces that
4694  *	can be chosen from this set of interface types (u32)
4695  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES: nested attribute containing a
4696  *	flag attribute for each interface type in this set
4697  * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: number of attributes
4698  * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: highest attribute number
4699  */
4700 enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs {
4701 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC,
4702 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX,
4703 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES,
4704 
4705 	/* keep last */
4706 	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT,
4707 	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT - 1
4708 };
4709 
4710 /**
4711  * enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs -- interface combination attributes
4712  *
4713  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC: (reserved)
4714  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS: Nested attributes containing the limits
4715  *	for given interface types, see &enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs.
4716  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM: u32 attribute giving the total number of
4717  *	interfaces that can be created in this group. This number doesn't
4718  *	apply to interfaces purely managed in software, which are listed
4719  *	in a separate attribute %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACES_SOFTWARE.
4720  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH: flag attribute specifying that
4721  *	beacon intervals within this group must be all the same even for
4722  *	infrastructure and AP/GO combinations, i.e. the GO(s) must adopt
4723  *	the infrastructure network's beacon interval.
4724  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS: u32 attribute specifying how many
4725  *	different channels may be used within this group.
4726  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
4727  *	of supported channel widths for radar detection.
4728  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
4729  *	of supported regulatory regions for radar detection.
4730  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD: u32 attribute specifying the minimum GCD of
4731  *	different beacon intervals supported by all the interface combinations
4732  *	in this group (if not present, all beacon intervals be identical).
4733  * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: number of attributes
4734  * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: highest attribute number
4735  *
4736  * Examples:
4737  *	limits = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{AP} <= 1 ], matching BI, channels = 1, max = 2
4738  *	=> allows an AP and a STA that must match BIs
4739  *
4740  *	numbers = [ #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8 ], BI min gcd, channels = 1, max = 8,
4741  *	=> allows 8 of AP/GO that can have BI gcd >= min gcd
4742  *
4743  *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 2 ], channels = 2, max = 2
4744  *	=> allows two STAs on different channels
4745  *
4746  *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 ], max = 4
4747  *	=> allows a STA plus three P2P interfaces
4748  *
4749  * The list of these four possiblities could completely be contained
4750  * within the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute to indicate
4751  * that any of these groups must match.
4752  *
4753  * "Combinations" of just a single interface will not be listed here,
4754  * a single interface of any valid interface type is assumed to always
4755  * be possible by itself. This means that implicitly, for each valid
4756  * interface type, the following group always exists:
4757  *	numbers = [ #{<type>} <= 1 ], channels = 1, max = 1
4758  */
4759 enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs {
4760 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC,
4761 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS,
4762 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM,
4763 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH,
4764 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS,
4765 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS,
4766 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS,
4767 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD,
4768 
4769 	/* keep last */
4770 	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB,
4771 	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB - 1
4772 };
4773 
4774 
4775 /**
4776  * enum nl80211_plink_state - state of a mesh peer link finite state machine
4777  *
4778  * @NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN: initial state, considered the implicit
4779  *	state of non existant mesh peer links
4780  * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT: mesh plink open frame has been sent to
4781  *	this mesh peer
4782  * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD: mesh plink open frame has been received
4783  *	from this mesh peer
4784  * @NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD: mesh plink confirm frame has been
4785  *	received from this mesh peer
4786  * @NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB: mesh peer link is established
4787  * @NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING: mesh peer link is being closed or cancelled
4788  * @NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED: all frames transmitted from this mesh
4789  *	plink are discarded
4790  * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: number of peer link states
4791  * @MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: highest numerical value of plink states
4792  */
4793 enum nl80211_plink_state {
4794 	NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN,
4795 	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT,
4796 	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD,
4797 	NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD,
4798 	NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB,
4799 	NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING,
4800 	NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED,
4801 
4802 	/* keep last */
4803 	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES,
4804 	MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES = NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES - 1
4805 };
4806 
4807 /**
4808  * enum nl80211_plink_action - actions to perform in mesh peers
4809  *
4810  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION: perform no action
4811  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN: start mesh peer link establishment
4812  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK: block traffic from this mesh peer
4813  * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS: number of possible actions
4814  */
4815 enum plink_actions {
4816 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION,
4817 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN,
4818 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK,
4819 
4820 	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS,
4821 };
4822 
4823 
4824 #define NL80211_KCK_LEN			16
4825 #define NL80211_KEK_LEN			16
4826 #define NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN		8
4827 
4828 /**
4829  * enum nl80211_rekey_data - attributes for GTK rekey offload
4830  * @__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
4831  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK: key encryption key (binary)
4832  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK: key confirmation key (binary)
4833  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR: replay counter (binary)
4834  * @NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: number of rekey attributes (internal)
4835  * @MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: highest rekey attribute (internal)
4836  */
4837 enum nl80211_rekey_data {
4838 	__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID,
4839 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK,
4840 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK,
4841 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR,
4842 
4843 	/* keep last */
4844 	NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA,
4845 	MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA = NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA - 1
4846 };
4847 
4848 /**
4849  * enum nl80211_hidden_ssid - values for %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID
4850  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE: do not hide SSID (i.e., broadcast it in
4851  *	Beacon frames)
4852  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN: hide SSID by using zero-length SSID element
4853  *	in Beacon frames
4854  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS: hide SSID by using correct length of SSID
4855  *	element in Beacon frames but zero out each byte in the SSID
4856  */
4857 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid {
4858 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE,
4859 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN,
4860 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS
4861 };
4862 
4863 /**
4864  * enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr - station WME attributes
4865  * @__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
4866  * @NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES: bitmap of uapsd queues. the format
4867  *	is the same as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field.
4868  * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP: max service period. the format is the same
4869  *	as the MAX_SP field in the QoS info field (but already shifted down).
4870  * @__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST: internal
4871  * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX: highest station WME attribute
4872  */
4873 enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr {
4874 	__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID,
4875 	NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES,
4876 	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP,
4877 
4878 	/* keep last */
4879 	__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST,
4880 	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX = __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST - 1
4881 };
4882 
4883 /**
4884  * enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr - attributes for PMKSA caching candidates
4885  * @__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
4886  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX: candidate index (u32; the smaller, the higher
4887  *	priority)
4888  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID: candidate BSSID (6 octets)
4889  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH: RSN pre-authentication supported (flag)
4890  * @NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: number of PMKSA caching candidate attributes
4891  *	(internal)
4892  * @MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: highest PMKSA caching candidate attribute
4893  *	(internal)
4894  */
4895 enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr {
4896 	__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID,
4897 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX,
4898 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID,
4899 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH,
4900 
4901 	/* keep last */
4902 	NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
4903 	MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE = NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE - 1
4904 };
4905 
4906 /**
4907  * enum nl80211_tdls_operation - values for %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION
4908  * @NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ: Send a TDLS discovery request
4909  * @NL80211_TDLS_SETUP: Setup TDLS link
4910  * @NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN: Teardown a TDLS link which is already established
4911  * @NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK: Enable TDLS link
4912  * @NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK: Disable TDLS link
4913  */
4914 enum nl80211_tdls_operation {
4915 	NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ,
4916 	NL80211_TDLS_SETUP,
4917 	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN,
4918 	NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK,
4919 	NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK,
4920 };
4921 
4922 /*
4923  * enum nl80211_ap_sme_features - device-integrated AP features
4924  * Reserved for future use, no bits are defined in
4925  * NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME yet.
4926 enum nl80211_ap_sme_features {
4927 };
4928  */
4929 
4930 /**
4931  * enum nl80211_feature_flags - device/driver features
4932  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS: This driver supports reflecting back
4933  *	TX status to the socket error queue when requested with the
4934  *	socket option.
4935  * @NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with HT datarates.
4936  * @NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER: This driver takes care of freeing up
4937  *	the connected inactive stations in AP mode.
4938  * @NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS: This driver has been tested
4939  *	to work properly to suppport receiving regulatory hints from
4940  *	cellular base stations.
4941  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL: (no longer available, only
4942  *	here to reserve the value for API/ABI compatibility)
4943  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SAE: This driver supports simultaneous authentication of
4944  *	equals (SAE) with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station
4945  *	mode
4946  * @NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN: This driver supports low priority scan
4947  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH: Scan flush is supported
4948  * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN: Support scanning using an AP vif
4949  * @NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER: The driver supports per-vif TX power setting
4950  * @NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN: The driver expects userspace to perform
4951  *	OBSS scans and generate 20/40 BSS coex reports. This flag is used only
4952  *	for drivers implementing the CONNECT API, for AUTH/ASSOC it is implied.
4953  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN: P2P GO implementation supports CT Window
4954  *	setting
4955  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS: P2P GO implementation supports opportunistic
4956  *	powersave
4957  * @NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE: The driver supports full state
4958  *	transitions for AP clients. Without this flag (and if the driver
4959  *	doesn't have the AP SME in the device) the driver supports adding
4960  *	stations only when they're associated and adds them in associated
4961  *	state (to later be transitioned into authorized), with this flag
4962  *	they should be added before even sending the authentication reply
4963  *	and then transitioned into authenticated, associated and authorized
4964  *	states using station flags.
4965  *	Note that even for drivers that support this, the default is to add
4966  *	stations in authenticated/associated state, so to add unauthenticated
4967  *	stations the authenticated/associated bits have to be set in the mask.
4968  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS: cfg80211 advertises channel limits
4969  *	(HT40, VHT 80/160 MHz) if this flag is set
4970  * @NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM: This driver supports a userspace Mesh
4971  *	Peering Management entity which may be implemented by registering for
4972  *	beacons or NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE events. The mesh beacon is
4973  *	still generated by the driver.
4974  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR: This driver supports an active monitor
4975  *	interface. An active monitor interface behaves like a normal monitor
4976  *	interface, but gets added to the driver. It ensures that incoming
4977  *	unicast packets directed at the configured interface address get ACKed.
4978  * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE: This driver supports dynamic
4979  *	channel bandwidth change (e.g., HT 20 <-> 40 MHz channel) during the
4980  *	lifetime of a BSS.
4981  * @NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a DS Parameter
4982  *	Set IE to probe requests.
4983  * @NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a WFA TPC Report IE
4984  *	to probe requests.
4985  * @NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET: This device, in client mode, supports Quiet Period
4986  *	requests sent to it by an AP.
4987  * @NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION: This device is capable of inserting the
4988  *	current tx power value into the TPC Report IE in the spectrum
4989  *	management TPC Report action frame, and in the Radio Measurement Link
4990  *	Measurement Report action frame.
4991  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION: This driver supports dynamic ACK timeout
4992  *	estimation (dynack). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK flag attribute is used
4993  *	to enable dynack.
4994  * @NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS: Device supports static spatial
4995  *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
4996  *	even on HT connections that should be using more chains.
4997  * @NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS: Device supports dynamic spatial
4998  *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
4999  *	and then wake the rest up as required after, for example,
5000  *	rts/cts handshake.
5001  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION: the device supports setting up WMM
5002  *	TSPEC sessions (TID aka TSID 0-7) with the %NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS
5003  *	command. Standard IEEE 802.11 TSPEC setup is not yet supported, it
5004  *	needs to be able to handle Block-Ack agreements and other things.
5005  * @NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE: Device supports configuring
5006  *	the vif's MAC address upon creation.
5007  *	See 'macaddr' field in the vif_params (cfg80211.h).
5008  * @NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Driver supports channel switching when
5009  *	operating as a TDLS peer.
5010  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
5011  *	random MAC address during scan (if the device is unassociated); the
5012  *	%NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR flag may be set for scans and the MAC
5013  *	address mask/value will be used.
5014  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports
5015  *	using a random MAC address for every scan iteration during scheduled
5016  *	scan (while not associated), the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
5017  *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
5018  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
5019  *	random MAC address for every scan iteration during "net detect", i.e.
5020  *	scan in unassociated WoWLAN, the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
5021  *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
5022  */
5023 enum nl80211_feature_flags {
5024 	NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS			= 1 << 0,
5025 	NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS				= 1 << 1,
5026 	NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER		= 1 << 2,
5027 	NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS		= 1 << 3,
5028 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL	= 1 << 4,
5029 	NL80211_FEATURE_SAE				= 1 << 5,
5030 	NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN		= 1 << 6,
5031 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH			= 1 << 7,
5032 	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN				= 1 << 8,
5033 	NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER			= 1 << 9,
5034 	NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN			= 1 << 10,
5035 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN			= 1 << 11,
5036 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS			= 1 << 12,
5037 	/* bit 13 is reserved */
5038 	NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS		= 1 << 14,
5039 	NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE		= 1 << 15,
5040 	NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM			= 1 << 16,
5041 	NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR			= 1 << 17,
5042 	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE	= 1 << 18,
5043 	NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES	= 1 << 19,
5044 	NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES		= 1 << 20,
5045 	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET				= 1 << 21,
5046 	NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION		= 1 << 22,
5047 	NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION		= 1 << 23,
5048 	NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS			= 1 << 24,
5049 	NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS			= 1 << 25,
5050 	NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION		= 1 << 26,
5051 	NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE			= 1 << 27,
5052 	NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= 1 << 28,
5053 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1 << 29,
5054 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR	= 1 << 30,
5055 	NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1 << 31,
5056 };
5057 
5058 /**
5059  * enum nl80211_ext_feature_index - bit index of extended features.
5060  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with VHT datarates.
5061  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM: This driver supports RRM. When featured, user can
5062  *	can request to use RRM (see %NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM) with
5063  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests, which will set
5064  *	the ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM flag in the association request even if
5065  *	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET is not advertized.
5066  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER: This device supports MU-MIMO air
5067  *	sniffer which means that it can be configured to hear packets from
5068  *	certain groups which can be configured by the
5069  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA attribute,
5070  *	or can be configured to follow a station by configuring the
5071  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR attribute.
5072  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME: This driver includes the actual
5073  *	time the scan started in scan results event. The time is the TSF of
5074  *	the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
5075  *	(if available).
5076  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF: Per BSS, this driver reports the
5077  *	time the last beacon/probe was received. The time is the TSF of the
5078  *	BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
5079  *	(if available).
5080  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL: This driver supports configuration of
5081  *	channel dwell time.
5082  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY: Driver supports beacon rate
5083  *	configuration (AP/mesh), supporting a legacy (non HT/VHT) rate.
5084  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT: Driver supports beacon rate
5085  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HT rates.
5086  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT: Driver supports beacon rate
5087  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with VHT rates.
5088  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA: This driver supports Fast Initial Link Setup
5089  *	with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station mode.
5090  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA: This driver supports randomized TA
5091  *	in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while not associated.
5092  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED: This driver supports
5093  *	randomized TA in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while associated.
5094  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: The driver supports sched_scan
5095  *	for reporting BSSs with better RSSI than the current connected BSS
5096  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI).
5097  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST: With this driver the
5098  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD attribute accepts a list of zero or more
5099  *	RSSI threshold values to monitor rather than exactly one threshold.
5100  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD: Driver SME supports FILS shared key
5101  *	authentication with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
5102  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
5103  *	handshake with PSK in station mode (PSK is passed as part of the connect
5104  *	and associate commands), doing it in the host might not be supported.
5105  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X: Device wants to do doing 4-way
5106  *	handshake with 802.1X in station mode (will pass EAP frames to the host
5107  *	and accept the set_pmk/del_pmk commands), doing it in the host might not
5108  *	be supported.
5109  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: Driver is capable of overriding
5110  *	the max channel attribute in the FILS request params IE with the
5111  *	actual dwell time.
5112  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver accepts broadcast probe
5113  *	response
5114  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: Driver supports sending
5115  *	the first probe request in each channel at rate of at least 5.5Mbps.
5116  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: Driver supports
5117  *	probe request tx deferral and suppression
5118  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL: Driver supports the %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL
5119  *	value in %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP.
5120  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN: Driver supports low span scan.
5121  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN: Driver supports low power scan.
5122  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN: Driver supports high accuracy scan.
5123  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD: HW/driver will offload DFS actions.
5124  *	Device or driver will do all DFS-related actions by itself,
5125  *	informing user-space about CAC progress, radar detection event,
5126  *	channel change triggered by radar detection event.
5127  *	No need to start CAC from user-space, no need to react to
5128  *	"radar detected" event.
5129  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: Driver supports sending and
5130  *	receiving control port frames over nl80211 instead of the netdevice.
5131  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: This Driver support data ack
5132  *	rssi if firmware support, this flag is to intimate about ack rssi
5133  *	support to nl80211.
5134  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS: Driver supports FQ-CoDel-enabled intermediate
5135  *      TXQs.
5136  *
5137  * @NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: number of extended features.
5138  * @MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: highest extended feature index.
5139  */
5140 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index {
5141 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS,
5142 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM,
5143 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER,
5144 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME,
5145 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
5146 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL,
5147 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
5148 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
5149 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT,
5150 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA,
5151 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA,
5152 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED,
5153 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
5154 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST,
5155 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD,
5156 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK,
5157 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X,
5158 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME,
5159 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
5160 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE,
5161 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION,
5162 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL,
5163 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN,
5164 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN,
5165 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN,
5166 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD,
5167 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
5168 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
5169 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS,
5170 
5171 	/* add new features before the definition below */
5172 	NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES,
5173 	MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES = NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES - 1
5174 };
5175 
5176 /**
5177  * enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr - optional supported
5178  *	protocols for probe-response offloading by the driver/FW.
5179  *	To be used with the %NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD attribute.
5180  *	Each enum value represents a bit in the bitmap of supported
5181  *	protocols. Typically a subset of probe-requests belonging to a
5182  *	supported protocol will be excluded from offload and uploaded
5183  *	to the host.
5184  *
5185  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS: Support for WPS ver. 1
5186  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2: Support for WPS ver. 2
5187  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P: Support for P2P
5188  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U: Support for 802.11u
5189  */
5190 enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr {
5191 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS =	1<<0,
5192 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2 =	1<<1,
5193 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P =	1<<2,
5194 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U =	1<<3,
5195 };
5196 
5197 /**
5198  * enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason - connection request failed reasons
5199  * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS: Maximum number of clients that can be
5200  *	handled by the AP is reached.
5201  * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT: Connection request is rejected due to ACL.
5202  */
5203 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason {
5204 	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS,
5205 	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT,
5206 };
5207 
5208 /**
5209  * enum nl80211_timeout_reason - timeout reasons
5210  *
5211  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED: Timeout reason unspecified.
5212  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN: Scan (AP discovery) timed out.
5213  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH: Authentication timed out.
5214  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC: Association timed out.
5215  */
5216 enum nl80211_timeout_reason {
5217 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED,
5218 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN,
5219 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH,
5220 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC,
5221 };
5222 
5223 /**
5224  * enum nl80211_scan_flags -  scan request control flags
5225  *
5226  * Scan request control flags are used to control the handling
5227  * of NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN
5228  * requests.
5229  *
5230  * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN, NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER, and
5231  * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY flags are exclusive of each other, i.e., only
5232  * one of them can be used in the request.
5233  *
5234  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY: scan request has low priority
5235  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH: flush cache before scanning
5236  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP: force a scan even if the interface is configured
5237  *	as AP and the beaconing has already been configured. This attribute is
5238  *	dangerous because will destroy stations performance as a lot of frames
5239  *	will be lost while scanning off-channel, therefore it must be used only
5240  *	when really needed
5241  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR: use a random MAC address for this scan (or
5242  *	for scheduled scan: a different one for every scan iteration). When the
5243  *	flag is set, depending on device capabilities the @NL80211_ATTR_MAC and
5244  *	@NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes may also be given in which case only
5245  *	the masked bits will be preserved from the MAC address and the remainder
5246  *	randomised. If the attributes are not given full randomisation (46 bits,
5247  *	locally administered 1, multicast 0) is assumed.
5248  *	This flag must not be requested when the feature isn't supported, check
5249  *	the nl80211 feature flags for the device.
5250  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: fill the dwell time in the FILS
5251  *	request parameters IE in the probe request
5252  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: accept broadcast probe responses
5253  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: send probe request frames at
5254  *	rate of at least 5.5M. In case non OCE AP is dicovered in the channel,
5255  *	only the first probe req in the channel will be sent in high rate.
5256  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: allow probe request
5257  *	tx deferral (dot11FILSProbeDelay shall be set to 15ms)
5258  *	and suppression (if it has received a broadcast Probe Response frame,
5259  *	Beacon frame or FILS Discovery frame from an AP that the STA considers
5260  *	a suitable candidate for (re-)association - suitable in terms of
5261  *	SSID and/or RSSI.
5262  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN: Span corresponds to the total time taken to
5263  *	accomplish the scan. Thus, this flag intends the driver to perform the
5264  *	scan request with lesser span/duration. It is specific to the driver
5265  *	implementations on how this is accomplished. Scan accuracy may get
5266  *	impacted with this flag.
5267  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER: This flag intends the scan attempts to consume
5268  *	optimal possible power. Drivers can resort to their specific means to
5269  *	optimize the power. Scan accuracy may get impacted with this flag.
5270  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY: Accuracy here intends to the extent of scan
5271  *	results obtained. Thus HIGH_ACCURACY scan flag aims to get maximum
5272  *	possible scan results. This flag hints the driver to use the best
5273  *	possible scan configuration to improve the accuracy in scanning.
5274  *	Latency and power use may get impacted with this flag.
5275  */
5276 enum nl80211_scan_flags {
5277 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY				= 1<<0,
5278 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH					= 1<<1,
5279 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP					= 1<<2,
5280 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR				= 1<<3,
5281 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME			= 1<<4,
5282 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP		= 1<<5,
5283 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE		= 1<<6,
5284 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION	= 1<<7,
5285 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN				= 1<<8,
5286 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER				= 1<<9,
5287 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY				= 1<<10,
5288 };
5289 
5290 /**
5291  * enum nl80211_acl_policy - access control policy
5292  *
5293  * Access control policy is applied on a MAC list set by
5294  * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP and %NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, to
5295  * be used with %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY.
5296  *
5297  * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED: Deny stations which are
5298  *	listed in ACL, i.e. allow all the stations which are not listed
5299  *	in ACL to authenticate.
5300  * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED: Allow the stations which are listed
5301  *	in ACL, i.e. deny all the stations which are not listed in ACL.
5302  */
5303 enum nl80211_acl_policy {
5304 	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED,
5305 	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED,
5306 };
5307 
5308 /**
5309  * enum nl80211_smps_mode - SMPS mode
5310  *
5311  * Requested SMPS mode (for AP mode)
5312  *
5313  * @NL80211_SMPS_OFF: SMPS off (use all antennas).
5314  * @NL80211_SMPS_STATIC: static SMPS (use a single antenna)
5315  * @NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic smps (start with a single antenna and
5316  *	turn on other antennas after CTS/RTS).
5317  */
5318 enum nl80211_smps_mode {
5319 	NL80211_SMPS_OFF,
5320 	NL80211_SMPS_STATIC,
5321 	NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
5322 
5323 	__NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST,
5324 	NL80211_SMPS_MAX = __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST - 1
5325 };
5326 
5327 /**
5328  * enum nl80211_radar_event - type of radar event for DFS operation
5329  *
5330  * Type of event to be used with NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT to inform userspace
5331  * about detected radars or success of the channel available check (CAC)
5332  *
5333  * @NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED: A radar pattern has been detected. The channel is
5334  *	now unusable.
5335  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED: Channel Availability Check has been finished,
5336  *	the channel is now available.
5337  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED: Channel Availability Check has been aborted, no
5338  *	change to the channel status.
5339  * @NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED: The Non-Occupancy Period for this channel is
5340  *	over, channel becomes usable.
5341  * @NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED: Channel Availability Check done on this
5342  *	non-operating channel is expired and no longer valid. New CAC must
5343  *	be done on this channel before starting the operation. This is not
5344  *	applicable for ETSI dfs domain where pre-CAC is valid for ever.
5345  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED: Channel Availability Check has been started,
5346  *	should be generated by HW if NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD is enabled.
5347  */
5348 enum nl80211_radar_event {
5349 	NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED,
5350 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED,
5351 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED,
5352 	NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED,
5353 	NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED,
5354 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED,
5355 };
5356 
5357 /**
5358  * enum nl80211_dfs_state - DFS states for channels
5359  *
5360  * Channel states used by the DFS code.
5361  *
5362  * @NL80211_DFS_USABLE: The channel can be used, but channel availability
5363  *	check (CAC) must be performed before using it for AP or IBSS.
5364  * @NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE: A radar has been detected on this channel, it
5365  *	is therefore marked as not available.
5366  * @NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE: The channel has been CAC checked and is available.
5367  */
5368 enum nl80211_dfs_state {
5369 	NL80211_DFS_USABLE,
5370 	NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE,
5371 	NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE,
5372 };
5373 
5374 /**
5375  * enum enum nl80211_protocol_features - nl80211 protocol features
5376  * @NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: nl80211 supports splitting
5377  *	wiphy dumps (if requested by the application with the attribute
5378  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP. Also supported is filtering the
5379  *	wiphy dump by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX or
5380  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV.
5381  */
5382 enum nl80211_protocol_features {
5383 	NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP =	1 << 0,
5384 };
5385 
5386 /**
5387  * enum nl80211_crit_proto_id - nl80211 critical protocol identifiers
5388  *
5389  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC: protocol unspecified.
5390  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP: BOOTP or DHCPv6 protocol.
5391  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL: EAPOL protocol.
5392  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA: APIPA protocol.
5393  * @NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO: must be kept last.
5394  */
5395 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id {
5396 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC,
5397 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP,
5398 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL,
5399 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA,
5400 	/* add other protocols before this one */
5401 	NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO
5402 };
5403 
5404 /* maximum duration for critical protocol measures */
5405 #define NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_MAX_DURATION		5000 /* msec */
5406 
5407 /**
5408  * enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags - flags for received management frame.
5409  *
5410  * Used by cfg80211_rx_mgmt()
5411  *
5412  * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED: frame was answered by device/driver.
5413  */
5414 enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags {
5415 	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED = 1 << 0,
5416 };
5417 
5418 /*
5419  * If this flag is unset, the lower 24 bits are an OUI, if set
5420  * a Linux nl80211 vendor ID is used (no such IDs are allocated
5421  * yet, so that's not valid so far)
5422  */
5423 #define NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX	0x80000000
5424 
5425 /**
5426  * struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info - vendor command data
5427  * @vendor_id: If the %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX flag is clear, then the
5428  *	value is a 24-bit OUI; if it is set then a separately allocated ID
5429  *	may be used, but no such IDs are allocated yet. New IDs should be
5430  *	added to this file when needed.
5431  * @subcmd: sub-command ID for the command
5432  */
5433 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info {
5434 	__u32 vendor_id;
5435 	__u32 subcmd;
5436 };
5437 
5438 /**
5439  * enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability - TDLS peer flags.
5440  *
5441  * Used by tdls_mgmt() to determine which conditional elements need
5442  * to be added to TDLS Setup frames.
5443  *
5444  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT: TDLS peer is HT capable.
5445  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT: TDLS peer is VHT capable.
5446  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM: TDLS peer is WMM capable.
5447  */
5448 enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability {
5449 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT = 1<<0,
5450 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT = 1<<1,
5451 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM = 1<<2,
5452 };
5453 
5454 /**
5455  * enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan - scanning plan for scheduled scan
5456  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
5457  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: interval between scan iterations. In
5458  *	seconds (u32).
5459  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: number of scan iterations in this
5460  *	scan plan (u32). The last scan plan must not specify this attribute
5461  *	because it will run infinitely. A value of zero is invalid as it will
5462  *	make the scan plan meaningless.
5463  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX: highest scheduled scan plan attribute number
5464  *	currently defined
5465  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST: internal use
5466  */
5467 enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan {
5468 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID,
5469 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
5470 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
5471 
5472 	/* keep last */
5473 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST,
5474 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX =
5475 		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST - 1
5476 };
5477 
5478 /**
5479  * struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust - RSSI adjustment parameters.
5480  *
5481  * @band: band of BSS that must match for RSSI value adjustment. The value
5482  *	of this field is according to &enum nl80211_band.
5483  * @delta: value used to adjust the RSSI value of matching BSS in dB.
5484  */
5485 struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust {
5486 	__u8 band;
5487 	__s8 delta;
5488 } __attribute__((packed));
5489 
5490 /**
5491  * enum nl80211_bss_select_attr - attributes for bss selection.
5492  *
5493  * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID: reserved.
5494  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI: Flag indicating only RSSI-based BSS selection
5495  *	is requested.
5496  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF: attribute indicating BSS
5497  *	selection should be done such that the specified band is preferred.
5498  *	When there are multiple BSS-es in the preferred band, the driver
5499  *	shall use RSSI-based BSS selection as a second step. The value of
5500  *	this attribute is according to &enum nl80211_band (u32).
5501  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
5502  *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
5503  *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
5504  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
5505  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX: highest bss select attribute number.
5506  * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use.
5507  *
5508  * One and only one of these attributes are found within %NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT
5509  * for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. It specifies the required BSS selection behaviour
5510  * which the driver shall use.
5511  */
5512 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr {
5513 	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID,
5514 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI,
5515 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF,
5516 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
5517 
5518 	/* keep last */
5519 	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
5520 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
5521 };
5522 
5523 /**
5524  * enum nl80211_nan_function_type - NAN function type
5525  *
5526  * Defines the function type of a NAN function
5527  *
5528  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH: function is publish
5529  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE: function is subscribe
5530  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP: function is follow-up
5531  */
5532 enum nl80211_nan_function_type {
5533 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH,
5534 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE,
5535 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP,
5536 
5537 	/* keep last */
5538 	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST,
5539 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE = __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST - 1,
5540 };
5541 
5542 /**
5543  * enum nl80211_nan_publish_type - NAN publish tx type
5544  *
5545  * Defines how to send publish Service Discovery Frames
5546  *
5547  * @NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is solicited
5548  * @NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is unsolicited
5549  */
5550 enum nl80211_nan_publish_type {
5551 	NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 0,
5552 	NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 1,
5553 };
5554 
5555 /**
5556  * enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason - NAN functions termination reason
5557  *
5558  * Defines termination reasons of a NAN function
5559  *
5560  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST: requested by user
5561  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED: timeout
5562  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR: errored
5563  */
5564 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason {
5565 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST,
5566 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED,
5567 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR,
5568 };
5569 
5570 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN 6
5571 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_SPEC_INFO_MAX_LEN 0xff
5572 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF_MAX_LEN 0xff
5573 
5574 /**
5575  * enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes - NAN function attributes
5576  * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID: invalid
5577  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type (u8).
5578  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID: 6 bytes of the service ID hash as
5579  *	specified in NAN spec. This is a binary attribute.
5580  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE: relevant if the function's type is
5581  *	publish. Defines the transmission type for the publish Service Discovery
5582  *	Frame, see &enum nl80211_nan_publish_type. Its type is u8.
5583  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST: relevant if the function is a solicited
5584  *	publish. Should the solicited publish Service Discovery Frame be sent to
5585  *	the NAN Broadcast address. This is a flag.
5586  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE: relevant if the function's type is
5587  *	subscribe. Is the subscribe active. This is a flag.
5588  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID: relevant if the function's type is follow up.
5589  *	The instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is u8.
5590  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID: relevant if the function's type
5591  *	is follow up. This is a u8.
5592  *	The requestor instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame.
5593  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST: the MAC address of the recipient of the
5594  *	follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is a binary attribute.
5595  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE: is this function limited for devices in a
5596  *	close range. The range itself (RSSI) is defined by the device.
5597  *	This is a flag.
5598  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL: strictly positive number of DWs this function should
5599  *	stay active. If not present infinite TTL is assumed. This is a u32.
5600  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO: array of bytes describing the service
5601  *	specific info. This is a binary attribute.
5602  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF: Service Receive Filter. This is a nested attribute.
5603  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes.
5604  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER: Receive Matching filter. This is a nested
5605  *	attribute. It is a list of binary values.
5606  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER: Transmit Matching filter. This is a
5607  *	nested attribute. It is a list of binary values.
5608  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID: The instance ID of the function.
5609  *	Its type is u8 and it cannot be 0.
5610  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON: NAN function termination reason.
5611  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason.
5612  *
5613  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR: internal
5614  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN function attribute
5615  */
5616 enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes {
5617 	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID,
5618 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE,
5619 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID,
5620 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE,
5621 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST,
5622 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE,
5623 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID,
5624 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID,
5625 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST,
5626 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE,
5627 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL,
5628 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO,
5629 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF,
5630 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER,
5631 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER,
5632 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID,
5633 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON,
5634 
5635 	/* keep last */
5636 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR,
5637 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR - 1
5638 };
5639 
5640 /**
5641  * enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes - NAN Service Response filter attributes
5642  * @__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID: invalid
5643  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE: present if the include bit of the SRF set.
5644  *	This is a flag.
5645  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF: Bloom Filter. Present if and only if
5646  *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS isn't present. This attribute is binary.
5647  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX: index of the Bloom Filter. Mandatory if
5648  *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF is present. This is a u8.
5649  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS: list of MAC addresses for the SRF. Present if
5650  *	and only if %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF isn't present. This is a nested
5651  *	attribute. Each nested attribute is a MAC address.
5652  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR: internal
5653  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN SRF attribute
5654  */
5655 enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes {
5656 	__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID,
5657 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE,
5658 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF,
5659 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX,
5660 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS,
5661 
5662 	/* keep last */
5663 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR,
5664 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR - 1,
5665 };
5666 
5667 /**
5668  * enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes - NAN match attributes
5669  * @__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID: invalid
5670  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL: the local function that had the
5671  *	match. This is a nested attribute.
5672  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
5673  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER: the peer function
5674  *	that caused the match. This is a nested attribute.
5675  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
5676  *
5677  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR: internal
5678  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN match attribute
5679  */
5680 enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes {
5681 	__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID,
5682 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL,
5683 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER,
5684 
5685 	/* keep last */
5686 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR,
5687 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR - 1
5688 };
5689 
5690 /**
5691  * nl80211_external_auth_action - Action to perform with external
5692  *     authentication request. Used by NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION.
5693  * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START: Start the authentication.
5694  * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT: Abort the ongoing authentication.
5695  */
5696 enum nl80211_external_auth_action {
5697 	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START,
5698 	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT,
5699 };
5700 
5701 #endif /* __LINUX_NL80211_H */
5702